tm.texi: Document TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN.
[gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi
1 @c Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001,
2 @c 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c This is part of the GCC manual.
4 @c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
5
6 @node Target Macros
7 @chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
8 @cindex machine description macros
9 @cindex target description macros
10 @cindex macros, target description
11 @cindex @file{tm.h} macros
12
13 In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
14 includes a C header file conventionally given the name
15 @file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
16 The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
17 about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
18 @file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
19 @file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
20 @file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
21 source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
22 containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
23 machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
24 if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
25 through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
26
27 @menu
28 * Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
29 * Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
30 * Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
31 * Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
32 * Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
33 * Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
34 * Escape Sequences:: Defining the value of target character escape sequences
35 * Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
36 * Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
37 * Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
38 * Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
39 * Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
40 * Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
41 * Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
42 * Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
43 * Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
44 * Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
45 * Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
46 * PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
47 * Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
48 * Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
49 * Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
50 * Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
51 * Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
52 * MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
53 * Misc:: Everything else.
54 @end menu
55
56 @node Target Structure
57 @section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
58 @cindex target hooks
59 @cindex target functions
60
61 @deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
62 The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
63 which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
64 machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
65 @file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
66 used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
67 for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
68 macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
69 @smallexample
70 #include "target.h"
71 #include "target-def.h"
72
73 /* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
74
75 #undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
76 #define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
77
78 struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
79 @end smallexample
80 @end deftypevar
81
82 Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
83 form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
84 ``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
85 from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
86 @code{targetm} structure.
87
88 @node Driver
89 @section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
90 @cindex driver
91 @cindex controlling the compilation driver
92
93 @c prevent bad page break with this line
94 You can control the compilation driver.
95
96 @table @code
97 @findex SWITCH_TAKES_ARG
98 @item SWITCH_TAKES_ARG (@var{char})
99 A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{char}}
100 takes arguments. The value should be the number of arguments that
101 option takes--zero, for many options.
102
103 By default, this macro is defined as
104 @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG}, which handles the standard options
105 properly. You need not define @code{SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} unless you
106 wish to add additional options which take arguments. Any redefinition
107 should call @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} and then check for
108 additional options.
109
110 @findex WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG
111 @item WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG (@var{name})
112 A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{name}}
113 takes arguments. The value should be the number of arguments that
114 option takes--zero, for many options. This macro rather than
115 @code{SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} is used for multi-character option names.
116
117 By default, this macro is defined as
118 @code{DEFAULT_WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG}, which handles the standard options
119 properly. You need not define @code{WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} unless you
120 wish to add additional options which take arguments. Any redefinition
121 should call @code{DEFAULT_WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} and then check for
122 additional options.
123
124 @findex SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION
125 @item SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION (@var{char})
126 A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{char}}
127 stops compilation before the generation of an executable. The value is
128 boolean, nonzero if the option does stop an executable from being
129 generated, zero otherwise.
130
131 By default, this macro is defined as
132 @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION}, which handles the standard
133 options properly. You need not define
134 @code{SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION} unless you wish to add additional
135 options which affect the generation of an executable. Any redefinition
136 should call @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION} and then check
137 for additional options.
138
139 @findex SWITCHES_NEED_SPACES
140 @item SWITCHES_NEED_SPACES
141 A string-valued C expression which enumerates the options for which
142 the linker needs a space between the option and its argument.
143
144 If this macro is not defined, the default value is @code{""}.
145
146 @findex TARGET_OPTION_TRANSLATE_TABLE
147 @item TARGET_OPTION_TRANSLATE_TABLE
148 If defined, a list of pairs of strings, the first of which is a
149 potential command line target to the @file{gcc} driver program, and the
150 second of which is a space-separated (tabs and other whitespace are not
151 supported) list of options with which to replace the first option. The
152 target defining this list is responsible for assuring that the results
153 are valid. Replacement options may not be the @code{--opt} style, they
154 must be the @code{-opt} style. It is the intention of this macro to
155 provide a mechanism for substitution that affects the multilibs chosen,
156 such as one option that enables many options, some of which select
157 multilibs. Example nonsensical definition, where @code{-malt-abi},
158 @code{-EB}, and @code{-mspoo} cause different multilibs to be chosen:
159
160 @smallexample
161 #define TARGET_OPTION_TRANSLATE_TABLE \
162 @{ "-fast", "-march=fast-foo -malt-abi -I/usr/fast-foo" @}, \
163 @{ "-compat", "-EB -malign=4 -mspoo" @}
164 @end smallexample
165
166 @findex DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
167 @item DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
168 A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
169 initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
170
171 The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
172 default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
173 choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
174 applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
175 options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
176 using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
177
178 This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
179 options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
180 that the other specs are easier to write.
181
182 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
183
184 @findex CPP_SPEC
185 @item CPP_SPEC
186 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
187 pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
188 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
189
190 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
191
192 @findex CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
193 @item CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
194 This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
195 than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
196 @code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
197
198 @findex CC1_SPEC
199 @item CC1_SPEC
200 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
201 pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
202 front ends.
203 It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
204 for GCC to pass to front ends.
205
206 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
207
208 @findex CC1PLUS_SPEC
209 @item CC1PLUS_SPEC
210 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
211 pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
212 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
213
214 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
215 Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
216 @code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
217 CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
218
219 @findex ASM_SPEC
220 @item ASM_SPEC
221 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
222 pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
223 you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
224 See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
225
226 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
227
228 @findex ASM_FINAL_SPEC
229 @item ASM_FINAL_SPEC
230 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
231 run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
232 Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
233 an example of this.
234
235 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
236
237 @findex AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
238 @item AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
239 Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
240 an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
241 read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
242 output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
243 @option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
244
245 If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
246 standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
247 cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
248 see @file{mips.h} for instance.
249
250 @findex LINK_SPEC
251 @item LINK_SPEC
252 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
253 pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
254 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
255
256 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
257
258 @findex LIB_SPEC
259 @item LIB_SPEC
260 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
261 between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
262 command given to the linker.
263
264 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
265 loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
266
267 @findex LIBGCC_SPEC
268 @item LIBGCC_SPEC
269 Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
270 how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
271 linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
272 the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
273
274 If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
275 passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
276
277 @findex STARTFILE_SPEC
278 @item STARTFILE_SPEC
279 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
280 difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
281 the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
282
283 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
284 standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
285
286 @findex ENDFILE_SPEC
287 @item ENDFILE_SPEC
288 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
289 difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
290 the very end of the command given to the linker.
291
292 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
293
294 @findex THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
295 @item THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
296 GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
297 However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
298 models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
299 @code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
300 blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
301 default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
302 @code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
303
304 @findex EXTRA_SPECS
305 @item EXTRA_SPECS
306 Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
307 @file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
308 @code{CC1_SPEC}.
309
310 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
311 containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
312 string constant that provides the specification.
313
314 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
315
316 @code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
317 related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
318 to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
319 these definitions.
320
321 For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
322 define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
323 used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
324 used.
325
326 The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
327
328 @example
329 #define EXTRA_SPECS \
330 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
331
332 #define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
333 @end example
334
335 The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
336 @smallexample
337 #undef CPP_SPEC
338 #define CPP_SPEC \
339 "%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
340 %@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} %@{mcall-aix: -D_CALL_AIX @} \
341 %@{!mcall-sysv: %@{!mcall-aix: %(cpp_sysv_default) @}@} \
342 %@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
343
344 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
345 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
346 @end smallexample
347
348 while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
349 @code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
350
351 @smallexample
352 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
353 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
354 @end smallexample
355
356 @findex LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL
357 @item LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL
358 Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
359 @file{libgcc.a} itself and should not pass @option{-L} options to the
360 linker. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
361 the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search and will
362 pass @option{-L} options to it.
363
364 @findex LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
365 @item LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
366 Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
367 @file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
368 the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
369 This macro is similar to @code{LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL}, except that it does
370 not affect @option{-L} options.
371
372 @findex LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
373 @item LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
374 The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
375 By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
376
377 @findex LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
378 @item LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
379 A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
380 linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
381 change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
382 define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
383 line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
384 the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
385 @code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
386
387 @findex LINK_ELIMINATE_DUPLICATE_LDIRECTORIES
388 @item LINK_ELIMINATE_DUPLICATE_LDIRECTORIES
389 A nonzero value causes @command{collect2} to remove duplicate @option{-L@var{directory}} search
390 directories from linking commands. Do not give it a nonzero value if
391 removing duplicate search directories changes the linker's semantics.
392
393 @findex MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
394 @item MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
395 Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
396 string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
397 target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
398 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
399
400 Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
401 the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
402 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
403 @xref{Target Fragment}.
404
405 @findex RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
406 @item RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
407 Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
408 a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
409 indicates an absolute file name.
410
411 @findex STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX
412 @item STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX
413 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
414 standard choice of @file{/usr/local/lib/gcc-lib/} as the default prefix to
415 try when searching for the executable files of the compiler.
416
417 @findex MD_EXEC_PREFIX
418 @item MD_EXEC_PREFIX
419 If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
420 @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
421 when the @option{-b} option is used, or the compiler is built as a cross
422 compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
423 to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
424
425 @findex STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
426 @item STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
427 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
428 standard choice of @file{/usr/local/lib/} as the default prefix to
429 try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
430
431 @findex MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
432 @item MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
433 If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
434 standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
435 @option{-b} option is used, or when the compiler is built as a cross
436 compiler.
437
438 @findex MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
439 @item MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
440 If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
441 standard prefixes. It is not searched when the @option{-b} option is
442 used, or when the compiler is built as a cross compiler.
443
444 @findex INIT_ENVIRONMENT
445 @item INIT_ENVIRONMENT
446 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
447 variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
448 loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
449 initialize the necessary environment variables.
450
451 @findex LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
452 @item LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
453 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
454 standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
455 try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
456 comes before @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
457
458 Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
459 replacement.
460
461 @findex MODIFY_TARGET_NAME
462 @item MODIFY_TARGET_NAME
463 Define this macro if you with to define command-line switches that modify the
464 default target name
465
466 For each switch, you can include a string to be appended to the first
467 part of the configuration name or a string to be deleted from the
468 configuration name, if present. The definition should be an initializer
469 for an array of structures. Each array element should have three
470 elements: the switch name (a string constant, including the initial
471 dash), one of the enumeration codes @code{ADD} or @code{DELETE} to
472 indicate whether the string should be inserted or deleted, and the string
473 to be inserted or deleted (a string constant).
474
475 For example, on a machine where @samp{64} at the end of the
476 configuration name denotes a 64-bit target and you want the @option{-32}
477 and @option{-64} switches to select between 32- and 64-bit targets, you would
478 code
479
480 @smallexample
481 #define MODIFY_TARGET_NAME \
482 @{ @{ "-32", DELETE, "64"@}, \
483 @{"-64", ADD, "64"@}@}
484 @end smallexample
485
486
487 @findex SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR
488 @item SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR
489 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to specify a
490 system-specific directory to search for header files before the standard
491 directory. @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} comes before
492 @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
493
494 Cross compilers do not use this macro and do not search the directory
495 specified.
496
497 @findex STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR
498 @item STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR
499 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
500 standard choice of @file{/usr/include} as the default prefix to
501 try when searching for header files.
502
503 Cross compilers do not use this macro and do not search either
504 @file{/usr/include} or its replacement.
505
506 @findex STANDARD_INCLUDE_COMPONENT
507 @item STANDARD_INCLUDE_COMPONENT
508 The ``component'' corresponding to @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}.
509 See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
510 If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
511
512 @findex INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
513 @item INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
514 Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
515 for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
516 usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
517 @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
518 @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
519 and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
520 and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
521 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
522
523 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
524 Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
525 string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
526 for C++-only directories,
527 and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
528 wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
529 the array with a null element.
530
531 The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
532 if any, in all upper-case letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
533 or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
534 operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
535
536 For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
537
538 @example
539 #define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
540 @{ \
541 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
542 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
543 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
544 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
545 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
546 @}
547 @end example
548 @end table
549
550 Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
551
552 @enumerate
553 @item
554 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
555
556 @item
557 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
558
559 @item
560 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
561
562 @item
563 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}.
564
565 @item
566 @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}.
567
568 @item
569 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
570 @end enumerate
571
572 Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
573
574 @enumerate
575 @item
576 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
577
578 @item
579 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
580
581 @item
582 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
583 (or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
584
585 @item
586 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}.
587
588 @item
589 @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}.
590
591 @item
592 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if any.
593
594 @item
595 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if any.
596
597 @item
598 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}.
599
600 @item
601 @file{/lib/}.
602
603 @item
604 @file{/usr/lib/}.
605 @end enumerate
606
607 @node Run-time Target
608 @section Run-time Target Specification
609 @cindex run-time target specification
610 @cindex predefined macros
611 @cindex target specifications
612
613 @c prevent bad page break with this line
614 Here are run-time target specifications.
615
616 @table @code
617 @findex TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS
618 @item TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS()
619 This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
620 built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target cpu, using
621 the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
622 @code{builtin_assert} defined in @file{c-common.c}. When the front end
623 calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
624 finished command line option processing your code can use those
625 results freely.
626
627 @code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
628 command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
629 the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
630 accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
631
632 @code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
633 object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
634 @code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
635 defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
636 with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
637 only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
638 example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
639 and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
640 @code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
641 defines only @code{_ABI64}.
642
643 You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
644 @code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
645 or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
646 assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
647 macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
648 to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
649 variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
650 @code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
651 preprocessing.
652
653 With @code{TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS} this macro obsoletes the
654 @code{CPP_PREDEFINES} target macro.
655
656 @findex TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS
657 @item TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS()
658 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
659 and is used for the target operating system instead.
660
661 With @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} this macro obsoletes the
662 @code{CPP_PREDEFINES} target macro.
663
664 @findex CPP_PREDEFINES
665 @item CPP_PREDEFINES
666 Define this to be a string constant containing @option{-D} options to
667 define the predefined macros that identify this machine and system.
668 These macros will be predefined unless the @option{-ansi} option (or a
669 @option{-std} option for strict ISO C conformance) is specified.
670
671 In addition, a parallel set of macros are predefined, whose names are
672 made by appending @samp{__} at the beginning and at the end. These
673 @samp{__} macros are permitted by the ISO standard, so they are
674 predefined regardless of whether @option{-ansi} or a @option{-std} option
675 is specified.
676
677 For example, on the Sun, one can use the following value:
678
679 @smallexample
680 "-Dmc68000 -Dsun -Dunix"
681 @end smallexample
682
683 The result is to define the macros @code{__mc68000__}, @code{__sun__}
684 and @code{__unix__} unconditionally, and the macros @code{mc68000},
685 @code{sun} and @code{unix} provided @option{-ansi} is not specified.
686
687 @findex extern int target_flags
688 @item extern int target_flags;
689 This declaration should be present.
690
691 @cindex optional hardware or system features
692 @cindex features, optional, in system conventions
693 @item TARGET_@dots{}
694 This series of macros is to allow compiler command arguments to
695 enable or disable the use of optional features of the target machine.
696 For example, one machine description serves both the 68000 and
697 the 68020; a command argument tells the compiler whether it should
698 use 68020-only instructions or not. This command argument works
699 by means of a macro @code{TARGET_68020} that tests a bit in
700 @code{target_flags}.
701
702 Define a macro @code{TARGET_@var{featurename}} for each such option.
703 Its definition should test a bit in @code{target_flags}. It is
704 recommended that a helper macro @code{TARGET_MASK_@var{featurename}}
705 is defined for each bit-value to test, and used in
706 @code{TARGET_@var{featurename}} and @code{TARGET_SWITCHES}. For
707 example:
708
709 @smallexample
710 #define TARGET_MASK_68020 1
711 #define TARGET_68020 (target_flags & TARGET_MASK_68020)
712 @end smallexample
713
714 One place where these macros are used is in the condition-expressions
715 of instruction patterns. Note how @code{TARGET_68020} appears
716 frequently in the 68000 machine description file, @file{m68k.md}.
717 Another place they are used is in the definitions of the other
718 macros in the @file{@var{machine}.h} file.
719
720 @findex TARGET_SWITCHES
721 @item TARGET_SWITCHES
722 This macro defines names of command options to set and clear
723 bits in @code{target_flags}. Its definition is an initializer
724 with a subgrouping for each command option.
725
726 Each subgrouping contains a string constant, that defines the option
727 name, a number, which contains the bits to set in
728 @code{target_flags}, and a second string which is the description
729 displayed by @option{--help}. If the number is negative then the bits specified
730 by the number are cleared instead of being set. If the description
731 string is present but empty, then no help information will be displayed
732 for that option, but it will not count as an undocumented option. The
733 actual option name is made by appending @samp{-m} to the specified name.
734 Non-empty description strings should be marked with @code{N_(@dots{})} for
735 @command{xgettext}. Please do not mark empty strings because the empty
736 string is reserved by GNU gettext. @code{gettext("")} returns the header entry
737 of the message catalog with meta information, not the empty string.
738
739 In addition to the description for @option{--help},
740 more detailed documentation for each option should be added to
741 @file{invoke.texi}.
742
743 One of the subgroupings should have a null string. The number in
744 this grouping is the default value for @code{target_flags}. Any
745 target options act starting with that value.
746
747 Here is an example which defines @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}
748 with opposite meanings, and picks the latter as the default:
749
750 @smallexample
751 #define TARGET_SWITCHES \
752 @{ @{ "68020", TARGET_MASK_68020, "" @}, \
753 @{ "68000", -TARGET_MASK_68020, \
754 N_("Compile for the 68000") @}, \
755 @{ "", TARGET_MASK_68020, "" @}@}
756 @end smallexample
757
758 @findex TARGET_OPTIONS
759 @item TARGET_OPTIONS
760 This macro is similar to @code{TARGET_SWITCHES} but defines names of command
761 options that have values. Its definition is an initializer with a
762 subgrouping for each command option.
763
764 Each subgrouping contains a string constant, that defines the fixed part
765 of the option name, the address of a variable, and a description string.
766 Non-empty description strings should be marked with @code{N_(@dots{})} for
767 @command{xgettext}. Please do not mark empty strings because the empty
768 string is reserved by GNU gettext. @code{gettext("")} returns the header entry
769 of the message catalog with meta information, not the empty string.
770
771 The variable, type @code{char *}, is set to the variable part of the
772 given option if the fixed part matches. The actual option name is made
773 by appending @samp{-m} to the specified name. Again, each option should
774 also be documented in @file{invoke.texi}.
775
776 Here is an example which defines @option{-mshort-data-@var{number}}. If the
777 given option is @option{-mshort-data-512}, the variable @code{m88k_short_data}
778 will be set to the string @code{"512"}.
779
780 @smallexample
781 extern char *m88k_short_data;
782 #define TARGET_OPTIONS \
783 @{ @{ "short-data-", &m88k_short_data, \
784 N_("Specify the size of the short data section") @} @}
785 @end smallexample
786
787 @findex TARGET_VERSION
788 @item TARGET_VERSION
789 This macro is a C statement to print on @code{stderr} a string
790 describing the particular machine description choice. Every machine
791 description should define @code{TARGET_VERSION}. For example:
792
793 @smallexample
794 #ifdef MOTOROLA
795 #define TARGET_VERSION \
796 fprintf (stderr, " (68k, Motorola syntax)");
797 #else
798 #define TARGET_VERSION \
799 fprintf (stderr, " (68k, MIT syntax)");
800 #endif
801 @end smallexample
802
803 @findex OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
804 @item OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
805 Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
806 a particular target machine. You can define a macro
807 @code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS} to take account of this. This macro, if
808 defined, is executed once just after all the command options have been
809 parsed.
810
811 Don't use this macro to turn on various extra optimizations for
812 @option{-O}. That is what @code{OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS} is for.
813
814 @findex OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS
815 @item OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS (@var{level}, @var{size})
816 Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
817 various optimization levels. This macro, if defined, is executed once
818 just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
819 of the command options have been parsed. Values set in this macro are
820 used as the default values for the other command line options.
821
822 @var{level} is the optimization level specified; 2 if @option{-O2} is
823 specified, 1 if @option{-O} is specified, and 0 if neither is specified.
824
825 @var{size} is nonzero if @option{-Os} is specified and zero otherwise.
826
827 You should not use this macro to change options that are not
828 machine-specific. These should uniformly selected by the same
829 optimization level on all supported machines. Use this macro to enable
830 machine-specific optimizations.
831
832 @strong{Do not examine @code{write_symbols} in
833 this macro!} The debugging options are not supposed to alter the
834 generated code.
835
836 @findex CAN_DEBUG_WITHOUT_FP
837 @item CAN_DEBUG_WITHOUT_FP
838 Define this macro if debugging can be performed even without a frame
839 pointer. If this macro is defined, GCC will turn on the
840 @option{-fomit-frame-pointer} option whenever @option{-O} is specified.
841 @end table
842
843 @node Per-Function Data
844 @section Defining data structures for per-function information.
845 @cindex per-function data
846 @cindex data structures
847
848 If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
849 provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
850 using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
851 nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
852 when another one comes along.
853
854 GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
855 contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
856 structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
857 @code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
858 to their own specific data.
859
860 If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
861 @code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
862 This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
863 @code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
864
865 One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
866 RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
867 RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
868 function, for level 0.
869
870 Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
871 all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
872 function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
873 stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
874 stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
875 @code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
876 the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
877 single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
878 longer supported.
879
880 The macro and function pointers are described below.
881
882 @table @code
883 @findex INIT_EXPANDERS
884 @item INIT_EXPANDERS
885 Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
886 is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
887 The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
888 function pointers below.
889
890 @findex init_machine_status
891 @item init_machine_status
892 This is a @code{void (*)(struct function *)} function pointer. If this
893 pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per function, before function
894 compilation starts, in order to allow the target to perform any target
895 specific initialization of the @code{struct function} structure. It is
896 intended that this would be used to initialize the @code{machine} of
897 that structure.
898
899 @code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC.
900 Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
901 @code{ggc_alloc}, including the structure itself.
902
903 @end table
904
905 @node Storage Layout
906 @section Storage Layout
907 @cindex storage layout
908
909 Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
910 alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
911 expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
912 @xref{Run-time Target}.
913
914 @table @code
915 @findex BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
916 @item BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
917 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
918 byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
919 This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
920 bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
921 be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
922 macro need not be a constant.
923
924 This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
925 bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
926
927 @findex BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
928 @item BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
929 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
930 word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
931
932 @findex WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
933 @item WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
934 Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
935 most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
936 memory locations and registers; GCC fundamentally assumes that the
937 order of words in memory is the same as the order in registers. This
938 macro need not be a constant.
939
940 @findex LIBGCC2_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
941 @item LIBGCC2_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
942 Define this macro if @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} is not constant. This must be a
943 constant value with the same meaning as @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN}, which will be
944 used only when compiling @file{libgcc2.c}. Typically the value will be set
945 based on preprocessor defines.
946
947 @findex FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
948 @item FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
949 Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
950 @code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
951 containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
952 have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
953
954 You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
955 multi-word integers.
956
957 @findex BITS_PER_UNIT
958 @item BITS_PER_UNIT
959 Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
960 unit (byte). If you do not define this macro the default is 8.
961
962 @findex BITS_PER_WORD
963 @item BITS_PER_WORD
964 Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
965 is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
966
967 @findex MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
968 @item MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
969 Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
970 @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
971 largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
972
973 @findex UNITS_PER_WORD
974 @item UNITS_PER_WORD
975 Number of storage units in a word; normally 4.
976
977 @findex MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
978 @item MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
979 Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
980 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
981 smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
982
983 @findex POINTER_SIZE
984 @item POINTER_SIZE
985 Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
986 width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
987 you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
988 a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
989
990 @findex POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
991 @item POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
992 A C expression whose value is greater than zero if pointers that need to be
993 extended from being @code{POINTER_SIZE} bits wide to @code{Pmode} are to
994 be zero-extended and zero if they are to be sign-extended. If the value
995 is less then zero then there must be an "ptr_extend" instruction that
996 extends a pointer from @code{POINTER_SIZE} to @code{Pmode}.
997
998 You need not define this macro if the @code{POINTER_SIZE} is equal
999 to the width of @code{Pmode}.
1000
1001 @findex PROMOTE_MODE
1002 @item PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
1003 A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
1004 is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
1005 stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
1006 scalar type.
1007
1008 On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
1009 register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
1010 @var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
1011 cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
1012 floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
1013 counterparts.
1014
1015 For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
1016 However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
1017 either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
1018 the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
1019 sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
1020 @var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
1021
1022 Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
1023
1024 @findex PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS
1025 @item PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS
1026 Define this macro if the promotion described by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}
1027 should also be done for outgoing function arguments.
1028
1029 @findex PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN
1030 @item PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN
1031 Define this macro if the promotion described by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}
1032 should also be done for the return value of functions.
1033
1034 If this macro is defined, @code{FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same
1035 promotions done by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
1036
1037 @findex PROMOTE_FOR_CALL_ONLY
1038 @item PROMOTE_FOR_CALL_ONLY
1039 Define this macro if the promotion described by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}
1040 should @emph{only} be performed for outgoing function arguments or
1041 function return values, as specified by @code{PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS}
1042 and @code{PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN}, respectively.
1043
1044 @findex PARM_BOUNDARY
1045 @item PARM_BOUNDARY
1046 Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
1047 bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
1048 regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
1049 size of an integer.
1050
1051 @findex STACK_BOUNDARY
1052 @item STACK_BOUNDARY
1053 Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
1054 stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
1055 desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
1056 if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
1057 this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
1058
1059 @findex PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
1060 @item PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
1061 Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
1062 stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
1063 is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
1064 macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
1065 @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1066
1067 @findex FORCE_PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY_IN_MAIN
1068 @item FORCE_PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY_IN_MAIN
1069 A C expression that evaluates true if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is
1070 not guaranteed by the runtime and we should emit code to align the stack
1071 at the beginning of @code{main}.
1072
1073 @cindex @code{PUSH_ROUNDING}, interaction with @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}
1074 If @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} is not defined, the stack will always be aligned
1075 to the specified boundary. If @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} is defined and specifies
1076 a less strict alignment than @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, the stack may
1077 be momentarily unaligned while pushing arguments.
1078
1079 @findex FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1080 @item FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1081 Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
1082
1083 @findex BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1084 @item BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1085 Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in bits.
1086
1087 @findex MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1088 @item MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1089 If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1090 object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1091 nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1092 on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1093
1094 @findex BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1095 @item BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1096 Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1097 machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1098 structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1099 by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1100
1101 @findex ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN
1102 @item ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1103 An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1104 alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1105 @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1106 alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1107 field alignment has not been set by the
1108 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1109
1110 @findex MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1111 @item MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1112 Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1113 Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1114 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1115 the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1116
1117 @findex DATA_ALIGNMENT
1118 @item DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1119 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1120 the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1121 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1122 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1123
1124 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1125
1126 @findex strcpy
1127 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1128 make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1129 arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1130 constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1131
1132 @findex CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT
1133 @item CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1134 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1135 that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1136 @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1137 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1138 align the object.
1139
1140 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1141
1142 The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1143 constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1144 constants can be done inline.
1145
1146 @findex LOCAL_ALIGNMENT
1147 @item LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1148 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1149 the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1150 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1151 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1152
1153 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1154
1155 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1156 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1157
1158 @findex EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1159 @item EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1160 Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1161 empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1162
1163 Note that @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} also affects the alignment
1164 that results from an empty field.
1165
1166 @findex STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1167 @item STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1168 Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1169 Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1170
1171 If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1172 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1173
1174 @findex STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1175 @item STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1176 Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1177 if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1178 go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1179
1180 @findex PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1181 @item PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1182 Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1183 alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1184
1185 The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1186 @code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1187 structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1188 that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1189 that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1190
1191 Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1192 @code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1193 four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1194 not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1195
1196 An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1197 structure.
1198
1199 If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1200 a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1201
1202 Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1203 bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1204 support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1205 @samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1206
1207 The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1208 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1209 Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1210
1211 Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1212 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1213 @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1214
1215 If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1216 bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1217 what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1218
1219 @example
1220 struct foo1
1221 @{
1222 char x;
1223 char :0;
1224 char y;
1225 @};
1226
1227 struct foo2
1228 @{
1229 char x;
1230 int :0;
1231 char y;
1232 @};
1233
1234 main ()
1235 @{
1236 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1237 sizeof (struct foo1));
1238 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1239 sizeof (struct foo2));
1240 exit (0);
1241 @}
1242 @end example
1243
1244 If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1245 get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1246
1247 @findex BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1248 @item BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1249 Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1250 to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1251
1252 @findex MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK
1253 @item MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (@var{field}, @var{mode})
1254 Return 1 if a structure or array containing @var{field} should be accessed using
1255 @code{BLKMODE}.
1256
1257 If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1258 mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1259 case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1260 retain the field's mode.
1261
1262 Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{c4x.h} for an example
1263 of how to use this macro to prevent a structure having a floating point
1264 field from being accessed in an integer mode.
1265
1266 @findex ROUND_TYPE_SIZE
1267 @item ROUND_TYPE_SIZE (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1268 Define this macro as an expression for the overall size of a type
1269 (given by @var{type} as a tree node) when the size computed in the
1270 usual way is @var{computed} and the alignment is @var{specified}.
1271
1272 The default is to round @var{computed} up to a multiple of @var{specified}.
1273
1274 @findex ROUND_TYPE_SIZE_UNIT
1275 @item ROUND_TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1276 Similar to @code{ROUND_TYPE_SIZE}, but sizes and alignments are
1277 specified in units (bytes). If you define @code{ROUND_TYPE_SIZE},
1278 you must also define this macro and they must be defined consistently
1279 with each other.
1280
1281 @findex ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN
1282 @item ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1283 Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1284 by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1285 way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1286 @var{specified}.
1287
1288 The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1289 the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1290
1291 @findex MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1292 @item MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1293 An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1294 machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1295 this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1296 appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1297 (DImode)} is assumed.
1298
1299 @findex VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
1300 @item VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P(@var{mode})
1301 Define this macro to be nonzero if the port is prepared to handle insns
1302 involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it must have move
1303 patterns for this mode.
1304
1305 @findex STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE
1306 @item STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1307 If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1308 specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1309 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1310 @var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1311 @code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1312 having its mode specified.
1313
1314 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1315 would most commonly define this macro if the
1316 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
1317 64-bit mode.
1318
1319 @findex STACK_SIZE_MODE
1320 @item STACK_SIZE_MODE
1321 If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1322 specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1323 @code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1324
1325 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1326 You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1327 pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1328
1329 @findex TARGET_FLOAT_FORMAT
1330 @item TARGET_FLOAT_FORMAT
1331 A code distinguishing the floating point format of the target machine.
1332 There are five defined values:
1333
1334 @table @code
1335 @findex IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT
1336 @item IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT
1337 This code indicates IEEE floating point. It is the default; there is no
1338 need to define this macro when the format is IEEE@.
1339
1340 @findex VAX_FLOAT_FORMAT
1341 @item VAX_FLOAT_FORMAT
1342 This code indicates the ``F float'' (for @code{float}) and ``D float''
1343 or ``G float'' formats (for @code{double}) used on the VAX and PDP-11@.
1344
1345 @findex IBM_FLOAT_FORMAT
1346 @item IBM_FLOAT_FORMAT
1347 This code indicates the format used on the IBM System/370.
1348
1349 @findex C4X_FLOAT_FORMAT
1350 @item C4X_FLOAT_FORMAT
1351 This code indicates the format used on the TMS320C3x/C4x.
1352
1353 @findex UNKNOWN_FLOAT_FORMAT
1354 @item UNKNOWN_FLOAT_FORMAT
1355 This code indicates any other format.
1356 @end table
1357
1358 If any other
1359 formats are actually in use on supported machines, new codes should be
1360 defined for them.
1361
1362 The ordering of the component words of floating point values stored in
1363 memory is controlled by @code{FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN}.
1364
1365 @findex MODE_HAS_NANS
1366 @item MODE_HAS_NANS (@var{mode})
1367 When defined, this macro should be true if @var{mode} has a NaN
1368 representation. The compiler assumes that NaNs are not equal to
1369 anything (including themselves) and that addition, subtraction,
1370 multiplication and division all return NaNs when one operand is
1371 NaN@.
1372
1373 By default, this macro is true if @var{mode} is a floating-point
1374 mode and the target floating-point format is IEEE@.
1375
1376 @findex MODE_HAS_INFINITIES
1377 @item MODE_HAS_INFINITIES (@var{mode})
1378 This macro should be true if @var{mode} can represent infinity. At
1379 present, the compiler uses this macro to decide whether @samp{x - x}
1380 is always defined. By default, the macro is true when @var{mode}
1381 is a floating-point mode and the target format is IEEE@.
1382
1383 @findex MODE_HAS_SIGNED_ZEROS
1384 @item MODE_HAS_SIGNED_ZEROS (@var{mode})
1385 True if @var{mode} distinguishes between positive and negative zero.
1386 The rules are expected to follow the IEEE standard:
1387
1388 @itemize @bullet
1389 @item
1390 @samp{x + x} has the same sign as @samp{x}.
1391
1392 @item
1393 If the sum of two values with opposite sign is zero, the result is
1394 positive for all rounding modes expect towards @minus{}infinity, for
1395 which it is negative.
1396
1397 @item
1398 The sign of a product or quotient is negative when exactly one
1399 of the operands is negative.
1400 @end itemize
1401
1402 The default definition is true if @var{mode} is a floating-point
1403 mode and the target format is IEEE@.
1404
1405 @findex MODE_HAS_SIGN_DEPENDENT_ROUNDING
1406 @item MODE_HAS_SIGN_DEPENDENT_ROUNDING (@var{mode})
1407 If defined, this macro should be true for @var{mode} if it has at
1408 least one rounding mode in which @samp{x} and @samp{-x} can be
1409 rounded to numbers of different magnitude. Two such modes are
1410 towards @minus{}infinity and towards +infinity.
1411
1412 The default definition of this macro is true if @var{mode} is
1413 a floating-point mode and the target format is IEEE@.
1414
1415 @findex ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
1416 @item ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
1417 If defined, this macro should be true if the prevailing rounding
1418 mode is towards zero. A true value has the following effects:
1419
1420 @itemize @bullet
1421 @item
1422 @code{MODE_HAS_SIGN_DEPENDENT_ROUNDING} will be false for all modes.
1423
1424 @item
1425 @file{libgcc.a}'s floating-point emulator will round towards zero
1426 rather than towards nearest.
1427
1428 @item
1429 The compiler's floating-point emulator will round towards zero after
1430 doing arithmetic, and when converting from the internal float format to
1431 the target format.
1432 @end itemize
1433
1434 The macro does not affect the parsing of string literals. When the
1435 primary rounding mode is towards zero, library functions like
1436 @code{strtod} might still round towards nearest, and the compiler's
1437 parser should behave like the target's @code{strtod} where possible.
1438
1439 Not defining this macro is equivalent to returning zero.
1440
1441 @findex LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL
1442 @item LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL (@var{size})
1443 This macro should return true if floats with @var{size}
1444 bits do not have a NaN or infinity representation, but use the largest
1445 exponent for normal numbers instead.
1446
1447 Defining this macro to true for @var{size} causes @code{MODE_HAS_NANS}
1448 and @code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES} to be false for @var{size}-bit modes.
1449 It also affects the way @file{libgcc.a} and @file{real.c} emulate
1450 floating-point arithmetic.
1451
1452 The default definition of this macro returns false for all sizes.
1453 @end table
1454
1455 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTOR_OPAQUE_P (tree @var{type})
1456 This target hook should return @code{true} a vector is opaque. That
1457 is, if no cast is needed when copying a vector value of type
1458 @var{type} into another vector lvalue of the same size. Vector opaque
1459 types cannot be initialized. The default is that there are no such
1460 types.
1461 @end deftypefn
1462
1463 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P (tree @var{record_type})
1464 This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1465 @var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1466 Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1467 unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1468 different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1469 alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1470 bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1471 the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1472 (iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1473 another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
1474 other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1475
1476 When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1477 of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1478 bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1479 and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1480 chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1481 size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1482 alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1483
1484 If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1485 the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1486 used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1487 precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1488 may affect its placement.
1489 @end deftypefn
1490
1491 @node Type Layout
1492 @section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1493
1494 These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1495 basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1496 the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1497 languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1498
1499 @table @code
1500 @findex INT_TYPE_SIZE
1501 @item INT_TYPE_SIZE
1502 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1503 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1504
1505 @findex SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1506 @item SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1507 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1508 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1509 (If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1510 unit.)
1511
1512 @findex LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1513 @item LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1514 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1515 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1516
1517 @findex ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1518 @item ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1519 On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1520 @code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C. In
1521 that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1522 the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1523 value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1524
1525 @findex MAX_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1526 @item MAX_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1527 Maximum number for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1528 target machine. If this is undefined, the default is
1529 @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
1530 largest value that @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE} can have at run-time. This is
1531 used in @code{cpp}.
1532
1533 @findex LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1534 @item LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1535 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1536 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1537 words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1538 macro must be at least 64.
1539
1540 @findex CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1541 @item CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1542 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1543 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1544 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1545
1546 @findex BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1547 @item BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1548 A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1549 C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1550 this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1551
1552 @findex FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1553 @item FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1554 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1555 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1556
1557 @findex DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1558 @item DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1559 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1560 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1561 words.
1562
1563 @findex LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1564 @item LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1565 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1566 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1567 words.
1568
1569 @findex MAX_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1570 Maximum number for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on the
1571 target machine. If this is undefined, the default is
1572 @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is
1573 the largest value that @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} can have at run-time.
1574 This is used in @code{cpp}.
1575
1576 @findex TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1577 @item TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1578 A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1579 assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1580 default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1581 @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
1582
1583 @findex WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1584 @item WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1585 A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1586 supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1587 value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1588 If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1589 is the default.
1590
1591 @findex DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1592 @item DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1593 An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1594 @code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1595 always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1596 and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1597
1598 @findex DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS
1599 @item DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS
1600 A C expression to determine whether to give an @code{enum} type
1601 only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range of possible values
1602 of that type. A nonzero value means to do that; a zero value means all
1603 @code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1604
1605 If you don't define the macro, the default is 0.
1606
1607 @findex SIZE_TYPE
1608 @item SIZE_TYPE
1609 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1610 for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1611 contents of the string.
1612
1613 The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1614 spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1615 appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1616 of the data type names defined in the function
1617 @code{init_decl_processing} in the file @file{c-decl.c}. You may not
1618 omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the compiler to
1619 crash on startup.
1620
1621 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1622 int"}.
1623
1624 @findex PTRDIFF_TYPE
1625 @item PTRDIFF_TYPE
1626 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1627 for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1628 @code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1629 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1630
1631 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1632
1633 @findex WCHAR_TYPE
1634 @item WCHAR_TYPE
1635 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1636 for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1637 the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1638 information.
1639
1640 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1641
1642 @findex WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1643 @item WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1644 A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1645 characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1646 @code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1647
1648 @findex MAX_WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1649 @item MAX_WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1650 Maximum number for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1651 characters. If this is undefined, the default is
1652 @code{WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
1653 largest value that @code{WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE} can have at run-time. This is
1654 used in @code{cpp}.
1655
1656 @findex GCOV_TYPE_SIZE
1657 @item GCOV_TYPE_SIZE
1658 A C expression for the size in bits of the type used for gcov counters on the
1659 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one
1660 @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE} in case it is greater or equal to 64-bit and
1661 @code{LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE} otherwise. You may want to re-define the type to
1662 ensure atomicity for counters in multithreaded programs.
1663
1664 @findex WINT_TYPE
1665 @item WINT_TYPE
1666 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1667 use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1668 @code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1669 contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1670 information.
1671
1672 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1673
1674 @findex INTMAX_TYPE
1675 @item INTMAX_TYPE
1676 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1677 can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1678 The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1679 string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1680
1681 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1682 @code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1683 much precision as @code{long long int}.
1684
1685 @findex UINTMAX_TYPE
1686 @item UINTMAX_TYPE
1687 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1688 can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1689 type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1690 of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1691
1692 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1693 @code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1694 unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1695 int}.
1696
1697 @findex TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1698 @item TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1699 The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1700 that looks like:
1701
1702 @example
1703 struct @{
1704 union @{
1705 void (*fn)();
1706 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1707 @};
1708 ptrdiff_t delta;
1709 @};
1710 @end example
1711
1712 @noindent
1713 The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1714 will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1715 Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1716 always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1717 distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1718 platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1719 that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1720 the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1721
1722 GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1723 this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1724 However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1725 set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1726 bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1727 address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1728 architecture, you should define this macro to
1729 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1730
1731 In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1732 in which function addresses are always even, according to
1733 @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1734 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1735
1736 @findex TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1737 @item TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1738 Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1739 macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1740 instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1741 function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1742 data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1743 pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1744
1745 If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1746 of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1747
1748 @findex TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1749 @item TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1750 By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1751 is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1752 the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1753 when special alignment is necessary. */
1754
1755 @findex TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1756 @item TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1757 There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1758 zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1759 specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1760 of words in each data entry.
1761 @end table
1762
1763 @node Escape Sequences
1764 @section Target Character Escape Sequences
1765 @cindex escape sequences
1766
1767 By default, GCC assumes that the C character escape sequences take on
1768 their ASCII values for the target. If this is not correct, you must
1769 explicitly define all of the macros below.
1770
1771 @table @code
1772 @findex TARGET_BELL
1773 @item TARGET_BELL
1774 A C constant expression for the integer value for escape sequence
1775 @samp{\a}.
1776
1777 @findex TARGET_ESC
1778 @item TARGET_ESC
1779 A C constant expression for the integer value of the target escape
1780 character. As an extension, GCC evaluates the escape sequences
1781 @samp{\e} and @samp{\E} to this.
1782
1783 @findex TARGET_TAB
1784 @findex TARGET_BS
1785 @findex TARGET_NEWLINE
1786 @item TARGET_BS
1787 @itemx TARGET_TAB
1788 @itemx TARGET_NEWLINE
1789 C constant expressions for the integer values for escape sequences
1790 @samp{\b}, @samp{\t} and @samp{\n}.
1791
1792 @findex TARGET_VT
1793 @findex TARGET_FF
1794 @findex TARGET_CR
1795 @item TARGET_VT
1796 @itemx TARGET_FF
1797 @itemx TARGET_CR
1798 C constant expressions for the integer values for escape sequences
1799 @samp{\v}, @samp{\f} and @samp{\r}.
1800 @end table
1801
1802 @node Registers
1803 @section Register Usage
1804 @cindex register usage
1805
1806 This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1807 has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1808
1809 The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1810 done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1811 on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1812 For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1813 For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1814
1815 @menu
1816 * Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1817 * Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1818 * Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1819 * Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1820 * Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1821 @end menu
1822
1823 @node Register Basics
1824 @subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1825
1826 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1827 Registers have various characteristics.
1828
1829 @table @code
1830 @findex FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1831 @item FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1832 Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1833 numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1834 pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1835 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1836
1837 @item FIXED_REGISTERS
1838 @findex FIXED_REGISTERS
1839 @cindex fixed register
1840 An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1841 all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1842 general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1843 pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1844 register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1845 machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1846 and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1847
1848 This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1849 commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1850 register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1851
1852 The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1853 the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1854 by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1855 the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1856 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1857
1858 @findex CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1859 @item CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1860 @cindex call-used register
1861 @cindex call-clobbered register
1862 @cindex call-saved register
1863 Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1864 clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1865 registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1866 available for general allocation of values that must live across
1867 function calls.
1868
1869 If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1870 automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1871 exit, if the register is used within the function.
1872
1873 @findex CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1874 @item CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1875 @cindex call-used register
1876 @cindex call-clobbered register
1877 @cindex call-saved register
1878 Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1879 that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1880 (@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1881 This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
1882 of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1883
1884 @findex HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED
1885 @item HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1886 @cindex call-used register
1887 @cindex call-clobbered register
1888 @cindex call-saved register
1889 A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1890 value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1891 call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1892 macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1893 preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1894
1895 @findex CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
1896 @findex fixed_regs
1897 @findex call_used_regs
1898 @item CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
1899 Zero or more C statements that may conditionally modify five variables
1900 @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1901 @code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1902 any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1903 of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1904 @code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1905 @code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1906 called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1907 @code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1908 from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1909 @code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1910 @code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1911 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1912 command options have been applied.
1913
1914 You need not define this macro if it has no work to do.
1915
1916 @cindex disabling certain registers
1917 @cindex controlling register usage
1918 If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1919 flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1920 @code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1921 registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also define
1922 the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} / @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
1923 to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
1924 is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
1925
1926 (However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1927 of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1928 controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1929 these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
1930
1931 @findex NON_SAVING_SETJMP
1932 @item NON_SAVING_SETJMP
1933 If this macro is defined and has a nonzero value, it means that
1934 @code{setjmp} and related functions fail to save the registers, or that
1935 @code{longjmp} fails to restore them. To compensate, the compiler
1936 avoids putting variables in registers in functions that use
1937 @code{setjmp}.
1938
1939 @findex INCOMING_REGNO
1940 @item INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1941 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1942 expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1943 corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1944 function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1945 outbound register.
1946
1947 @findex OUTGOING_REGNO
1948 @item OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1949 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1950 expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1951 corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1952 function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1953 register.
1954
1955 @findex LOCAL_REGNO
1956 @item LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1957 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1958 expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1959 register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1960 need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1961 gotos.
1962
1963 @ignore
1964 @findex PC_REGNUM
1965 @item PC_REGNUM
1966 If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1967 register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
1968 @end ignore
1969 @end table
1970
1971 @node Allocation Order
1972 @subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1973 @cindex order of register allocation
1974 @cindex register allocation order
1975
1976 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1977 Registers are allocated in order.
1978
1979 @table @code
1980 @findex REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1981 @item REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1982 If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
1983 numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
1984 to use them (from most preferred to least).
1985
1986 If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
1987 (all else being equal).
1988
1989 One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
1990 registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
1991 instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
1992 machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
1993 the highest numbered allocable register first.
1994
1995 @findex ORDER_REGS_FOR_LOCAL_ALLOC
1996 @item ORDER_REGS_FOR_LOCAL_ALLOC
1997 A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
1998 hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
1999
2000 Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
2001 Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
2002 register; and so on.
2003
2004 The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
2005 @code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
2006
2007 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2008 @end table
2009
2010 @node Values in Registers
2011 @subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2012
2013 This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2014 (specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2015 consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2016
2017 @table @code
2018 @findex HARD_REGNO_NREGS
2019 @item HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2020 A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2021 at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2022 @var{mode}.
2023
2024 On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2025 definition of this macro is
2026
2027 @smallexample
2028 #define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2029 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
2030 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2031 @end smallexample
2032
2033 @findex HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2034 @item HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2035 A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2036 of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2037 registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2038 are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2039
2040 @smallexample
2041 #define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2042 @end smallexample
2043
2044 You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2045 because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2046
2047 @cindex register pairs
2048 On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2049 register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2050 odd register numbers for such modes.
2051
2052 The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2053 @samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2054 register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2055 value into the register and back out not alter it.
2056
2057 Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2058 all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2059 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2060 you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2061 is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2062 and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2063 to be tieable.
2064
2065 Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2066 Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2067 in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2068 can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2069 mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2070 registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2071
2072 On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2073 modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2074 registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2075 non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2076 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2077 floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2078 normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2079 unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2080 register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2081
2082 The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2083 they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2084 instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2085 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2086 constraints for those instructions.
2087
2088 On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2089 so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2090 register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2091 floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2092 be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2093
2094 @findex MODES_TIEABLE_P
2095 @item MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2096 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2097 @var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2098
2099 If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2100 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2101 any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2102 should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2103 this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2104 accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2105
2106 You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2107 possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2108 allocation.
2109
2110 @findex AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2111 @item AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2112 Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2113 registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2114 @code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2115 @end table
2116
2117 @node Leaf Functions
2118 @subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2119
2120 @cindex leaf functions
2121 @cindex functions, leaf
2122 On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2123 more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2124 means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2125 are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2126 normally arrive.
2127
2128 The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2129 other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2130 registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2131 function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2132 handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2133 functions''.
2134
2135 GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2136 suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2137 registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2138 accomplish this.
2139
2140 @table @code
2141 @findex LEAF_REGISTERS
2142 @item LEAF_REGISTERS
2143 Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2144 contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2145 function treatment.
2146
2147 If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2148 registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2149 GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2150 used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2151 in this vector.
2152
2153 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2154 the treatment of leaf functions.
2155
2156 @findex LEAF_REG_REMAP
2157 @item LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2158 A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2159 should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2160
2161 If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2162 function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2163 will cause the compiler to abort.
2164
2165 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2166 treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2167 this.
2168 @end table
2169
2170 @findex current_function_is_leaf
2171 @findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2172 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2173 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2174 specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2175 which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2176 set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2177 compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2178 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2179 functions which only use leaf registers.
2180 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after reload and is
2181 only useful if @code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2182 @c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2183 @c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2184
2185 @node Stack Registers
2186 @subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2187
2188 There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2189 ``registers'' form a stack, as in the 80387 coprocessor for the 80386.
2190 Stack registers are normally written by pushing onto the stack, and are
2191 numbered relative to the top of the stack.
2192
2193 Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2194 they must be consecutively numbered.
2195
2196 @table @code
2197 @findex STACK_REGS
2198 @item STACK_REGS
2199 Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2200
2201 @findex FIRST_STACK_REG
2202 @item FIRST_STACK_REG
2203 The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2204 of the stack.
2205
2206 @findex LAST_STACK_REG
2207 @item LAST_STACK_REG
2208 The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2209 the stack.
2210 @end table
2211
2212 @node Register Classes
2213 @section Register Classes
2214 @cindex register class definitions
2215 @cindex class definitions, register
2216
2217 On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2218 For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2219 certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2220 restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2221
2222 You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2223 which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2224 that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2225
2226 @findex ALL_REGS
2227 @findex NO_REGS
2228 In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2229 class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2230 class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2231 union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2232
2233 @findex GENERAL_REGS
2234 One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2235 terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2236 @samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2237 the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2238 to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2239
2240 Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2241 then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2242
2243 The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2244 constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2245 You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2246 them in operand constraints.
2247
2248 You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2249 instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2250 either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2251 certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2252 which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code.
2253
2254 You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2255 classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2256 contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2257 in their union.
2258
2259 When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2260 certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2261 Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2262 a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2263 specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2264
2265 Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2266 instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2267 each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2268 mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2269 single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2270 this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2271 instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2272 single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2273 @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2274
2275 @table @code
2276 @findex enum reg_class
2277 @item enum reg_class
2278 An enumeral type that must be defined with all the register class names
2279 as enumeral values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2280 must be the last register class, followed by one more enumeral value,
2281 @code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2282 tells how many classes there are.
2283
2284 Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2285 the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2286 in many of the tables described below.
2287
2288 @findex N_REG_CLASSES
2289 @item N_REG_CLASSES
2290 The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2291
2292 @example
2293 #define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2294 @end example
2295
2296 @findex REG_CLASS_NAMES
2297 @item REG_CLASS_NAMES
2298 An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2299 constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2300
2301 @findex REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2302 @item REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2303 An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2304 which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2305 @var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2306 register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2307
2308 When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2309 Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2310 several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2311 for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2312 In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2313 registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2314 so on.
2315
2316 @findex REGNO_REG_CLASS
2317 @item REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2318 A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2319 @var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2320 which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2321 register.
2322
2323 @findex BASE_REG_CLASS
2324 @item BASE_REG_CLASS
2325 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2326 base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2327 which is the register value plus a displacement.
2328
2329 @findex MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS
2330 @item MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2331 This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2332 the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2333 @var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2334 @code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2335
2336 @findex INDEX_REG_CLASS
2337 @item INDEX_REG_CLASS
2338 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2339 index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2340 address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2341 added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2342
2343 @findex CONSTRAINT_LEN
2344 @item CONSTRAINT_LEN (@var{char}, @var{str})
2345 For the constraint at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter
2346 @var{c}, return the length. This allows you to have register class /
2347 constant / extra constraints that are longer than a single letter;
2348 you don't need to define this macro if you can do with single-letter
2349 constraints only. The definition of this macro should use
2350 DEFAULT_CONSTRAINT_LEN for all the characters that you don't want
2351 to handle specially.
2352 There are some sanity checks in genoutput.c that check the constraint lengths
2353 for the md file, so you can also use this macro to help you while you are
2354 transitioning from a byzantine single-letter-constraint scheme: when you
2355 return a negative length for a constraint you want to re-use, genoutput
2356 will complain about every instance where it is used in the md file.
2357
2358 @findex REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER
2359 @item REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2360 A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2361 letters for register classes. If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2362 value should be the register class corresponding to it. Otherwise,
2363 the value should be @code{NO_REGS}. The register letter @samp{r},
2364 corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2365 to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2366
2367 @findex REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT
2368 @item REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (@var{char}, @var{str})
2369 Like @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}, but you also get the constraint string
2370 passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between
2371 different variants.
2372
2373 @findex REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P
2374 @item REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2375 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2376 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses. It may be
2377 either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2378 allocated such a hard register.
2379
2380 @findex REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P
2381 @item REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2382 A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2383 that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2384 @var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2385 reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2386 you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2387 @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2388
2389 @findex REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P
2390 @item REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2391 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2392 suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2393 either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2394 allocated such a hard register.
2395
2396 The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2397 the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2398 two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2399 labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2400 labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2401 may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2402 looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2403 only if neither labeling works.
2404
2405 @findex PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS
2406 @item PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2407 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2408 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2409 @var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2410 another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2411 safe:
2412
2413 @example
2414 #define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2415 @end example
2416
2417 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2418 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2419 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2420 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2421 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2422
2423 If @var{x} is a @code{const_double}, by returning @code{NO_REGS}
2424 you can force @var{x} into a memory constant. This is useful on
2425 certain machines where immediate floating values cannot be loaded into
2426 certain kinds of registers.
2427
2428 @findex PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2429 @item PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2430 Like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2431 input reloads. If you don't define this macro, the default is to use
2432 @var{class}, unchanged.
2433
2434 @findex LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS
2435 @item LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2436 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2437 to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2438 @var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2439 ordinarily be used.
2440
2441 Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2442 there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2443
2444 The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2445 smaller class.
2446
2447 Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2448 require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2449
2450 @findex SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS
2451 @findex SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2452 @findex SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2453 @item SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2454 @itemx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2455 @itemx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2456 Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2457 from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2458 @samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2459 from general registers, but not memory. Some machines allow copying all
2460 registers to and from memory, but require a scratch register for stores
2461 to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic address on the RT,
2462 and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC when compiling
2463 PIC)@. In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are
2464 required.
2465
2466 You should define these macros to indicate to the reload phase that it may
2467 need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2468 register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2469 register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2470 you should define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2471 largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2472 intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2473
2474 If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2475 intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2476 should be defined to return the largest register class required. If the
2477 requirements for input and output reloads are the same, the macro
2478 @code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should be used instead of defining both
2479 macros identically.
2480
2481 The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2482 Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2483 can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2484 @var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2485 macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2486
2487 If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2488 intermediate register), you should define patterns for
2489 @samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2490 (@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which will normally be
2491 implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2492 @samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2493 register.
2494
2495 Define constraints for the reload register and scratch register that
2496 contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2497 class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2498 value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2499 register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2500 Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2501
2502 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2503 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2504 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2505 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2506
2507 These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2508 registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2509 registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2510 would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2511 the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2512 intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2513 general registers.
2514
2515 @findex SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED
2516 @item SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2517 Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2518 to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
2519 those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2520 @var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2521 class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2522 and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2523
2524 Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2525
2526 @findex SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX
2527 @item SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2528 Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2529 allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2530 If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2531 defined by this macro.
2532
2533 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2534 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2535
2536 @findex SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE
2537 @item SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2538 When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2539 registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2540 hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2541 load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2542 same as that of @var{mode}.
2543
2544 This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2545 bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2546 in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2547 registers.
2548
2549 However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2550 the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2551 differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2552 widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2553 suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2554 details.
2555
2556 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2557 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2558 is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2559
2560 @findex SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES
2561 @item SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES
2562 On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
2563 insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
2564 to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
2565 if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
2566 insn.
2567
2568 Define @code{SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES} to be an expression with a nonzero
2569 value on these machines. When this macro has a nonzero value, the
2570 compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of hard registers.
2571
2572 It is always safe to define this macro with a nonzero value, but if you
2573 unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
2574 that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this macro
2575 with a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out of
2576 spill registers and print a fatal error message. For most machines, you
2577 should not define this macro at all.
2578
2579 @findex CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P
2580 @item CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (@var{class})
2581 A C expression whose value is nonzero if pseudos that have been assigned
2582 to registers of class @var{class} would likely be spilled because
2583 registers of @var{class} are needed for spill registers.
2584
2585 The default value of this macro returns 1 if @var{class} has exactly one
2586 register and zero otherwise. On most machines, this default should be
2587 used. Only define this macro to some other expression if pseudos
2588 allocated by @file{local-alloc.c} end up in memory because their hard
2589 registers were needed for spill registers. If this macro returns nonzero
2590 for those classes, those pseudos will only be allocated by
2591 @file{global.c}, which knows how to reallocate the pseudo to another
2592 register. If there would not be another register available for
2593 reallocation, you should not change the definition of this macro since
2594 the only effect of such a definition would be to slow down register
2595 allocation.
2596
2597 @findex CLASS_MAX_NREGS
2598 @item CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2599 A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2600 of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2601
2602 This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2603 the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2604 should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2605 @var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2606
2607 This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2608 in the reload pass.
2609
2610 @item CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
2611 If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2612 a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
2613
2614 For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2615 floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2616 Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2617 does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2618 register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2619 as below:
2620
2621 @example
2622 #define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2623 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2624 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
2625 @end example
2626 @end table
2627
2628 Three other special macros describe which operands fit which constraint
2629 letters.
2630
2631 @table @code
2632 @findex CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P
2633 @item CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2634 A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2635 letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
2636 particular ranges of integer values. If @var{c} is one of those
2637 letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
2638 the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is
2639 not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
2640 @var{value}.
2641
2642 @findex CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P
2643 @item CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2644 Like @code{CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2645 string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2646 between different variants.
2647
2648 @findex CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P
2649 @item CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2650 A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2651 letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
2652 (@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
2653
2654 If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
2655 @var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
2656 range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is not one of those
2657 letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2658
2659 @code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
2660 @code{DImode} fixed-point constants. A given letter can accept either
2661 or both kinds of values. It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
2662 between these kinds.
2663
2664 @findex CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P
2665 @item CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2666 Like @code{CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2667 string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2668 between different variants.
2669
2670 @findex EXTRA_CONSTRAINT
2671 @item EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
2672 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2673 letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
2674 memory references, for the target machine. Any letter that is not
2675 elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} /
2676 @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
2677 may be used. Normally this macro will not be defined.
2678
2679 If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
2680 if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
2681 constraint letter @var{c}. If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
2682 constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2683
2684 For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
2685 in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address. Constraint
2686 letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
2687 @emph{not} contain a symbolic address. An alternative is specified with
2688 a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output. The next
2689 alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
2690 does not include r0 on the output.
2691
2692 @findex EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR
2693 @item EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2694 Like @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, but you also get the constraint string passed
2695 in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between different
2696 variants.
2697
2698 @findex EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT
2699 @item EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
2700 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2701 letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, that should
2702 be treated like memory constraints by the reload pass.
2703
2704 It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
2705 at the start of @var{str}, the first letter of which is the letter @var{c},
2706 comprises a subset of all memory references including
2707 all those whose address is simply a base register. This allows the reload
2708 pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
2709 type of @var{c}, by copying its address into a base register.
2710
2711 For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
2712 memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
2713 register. The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined via
2714 @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} as representing a memory address of this type.
2715 If the letter @samp{Q} is marked as @code{EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT},
2716 a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any memory operand, because the
2717 reload pass knows it can be reloaded by copying the memory address
2718 into a base register if required. This is analogous to the way
2719 a @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
2720
2721 @findex EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT
2722 @item EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
2723 A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2724 letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} /
2725 @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR}, that should
2726 be treated like address constraints by the reload pass.
2727
2728 It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
2729 at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter @var{c}, comprises
2730 a subset of all memory addresses including
2731 all those that consist of just a base register. This allows the reload
2732 pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
2733 type of @var{str}, by copying it into a base register.
2734
2735 Any constraint marked as @code{EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT} can only
2736 be used with the @code{address_operand} predicate. It is treated
2737 analogously to the @samp{p} constraint.
2738 @end table
2739
2740 @node Stack and Calling
2741 @section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
2742 @cindex calling conventions
2743
2744 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2745 This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
2746
2747 @menu
2748 * Frame Layout::
2749 * Exception Handling::
2750 * Stack Checking::
2751 * Frame Registers::
2752 * Elimination::
2753 * Stack Arguments::
2754 * Register Arguments::
2755 * Scalar Return::
2756 * Aggregate Return::
2757 * Caller Saves::
2758 * Function Entry::
2759 * Profiling::
2760 * Tail Calls::
2761 @end menu
2762
2763 @node Frame Layout
2764 @subsection Basic Stack Layout
2765 @cindex stack frame layout
2766 @cindex frame layout
2767
2768 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2769 Here is the basic stack layout.
2770
2771 @table @code
2772 @findex STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2773 @item STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2774 Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
2775 pointer to a smaller address.
2776
2777 When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{},'' it means that the
2778 compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
2779 definition used does not matter.
2780
2781 @findex STACK_PUSH_CODE
2782 @item STACK_PUSH_CODE
2783
2784 This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
2785 on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
2786 @code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
2787
2788 The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
2789 and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
2790 the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
2791 to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
2792 space for the next item on the stack.
2793
2794 The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
2795 defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
2796 which is often wrong.
2797
2798 @findex FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2799 @item FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2800 Define this macro if the addresses of local variable slots are at negative
2801 offsets from the frame pointer.
2802
2803 @findex ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
2804 @item ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
2805 Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
2806 addresses on the stack.
2807
2808 @findex STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
2809 @item STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
2810 Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
2811
2812 If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
2813 subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2814 Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
2815 value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2816 @c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
2817 @c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
2818
2819 @findex STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
2820 @item STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
2821 Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
2822 The non-zero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
2823
2824 On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is non-zero or where there
2825 is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
2826 alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
2827 stack alignment and do it in the backend.
2828
2829 @findex STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
2830 @item STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
2831 Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
2832 outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
2833 zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
2834
2835 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
2836 the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
2837
2838 @findex FIRST_PARM_OFFSET
2839 @item FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
2840 Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
2841 address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
2842 function.
2843
2844 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
2845 the first argument's address.
2846
2847 @findex STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET
2848 @item STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
2849 Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
2850 on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
2851
2852 The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
2853 length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
2854 machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
2855
2856 @findex DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS
2857 @item DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
2858 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
2859 frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
2860 @var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
2861 itself.
2862
2863 If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
2864 of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
2865 address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
2866
2867 @findex SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
2868 @item SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
2869 If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
2870 setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
2871 on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
2872 before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
2873 define this macro.
2874
2875 @findex BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE
2876 @item BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE
2877 If defined, a C expression that contains an rtx that is used to store
2878 the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
2879 The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
2880 machines. One reason you may need to define this macro is if
2881 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
2882
2883 @findex RETURN_ADDR_RTX
2884 @item RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
2885 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
2886 address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
2887 the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
2888 frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
2889 @code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
2890
2891 The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
2892 @var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is not way to
2893 determine the return address of other frames.
2894
2895 @findex RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
2896 @item RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
2897 Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
2898 from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
2899
2900 @findex INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
2901 @item INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
2902 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
2903 incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
2904 prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
2905 value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
2906 the stack.
2907
2908 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
2909 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
2910
2911 If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
2912 @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
2913
2914 @findex INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
2915 @item INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
2916 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
2917 from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
2918 frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
2919 the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
2920 previous frame, just before the call instruction.
2921
2922 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
2923 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
2924
2925 @findex ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
2926 @item ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
2927 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
2928 from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
2929 final value should coincide with that calculated by
2930 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
2931 during virtual register instantiation.
2932
2933 The default value for this macro is @code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl)},
2934 which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
2935 immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
2936 some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
2937 and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
2938
2939 You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
2940 want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
2941 DWARF 2.
2942
2943 @findex SMALL_STACK
2944 @item SMALL_STACK
2945 Define this macro if the stack size for the target is very small. This
2946 has the effect of disabling gcc's built-in @samp{alloca}, though
2947 @samp{__builtin_alloca} is not affected.
2948 @end table
2949
2950 @node Exception Handling
2951 @subsection Exception Handling Support
2952 @cindex exception handling
2953
2954 @table @code
2955 @findex EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO
2956 @item EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
2957 A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
2958 data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
2959 @var{N} registers are usable.
2960
2961 The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
2962 handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
2963 should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
2964 but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
2965 2 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
2966
2967 You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
2968 handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
2969
2970 @findex EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
2971 @item EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
2972 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
2973 to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
2974 This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
2975 It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
2976
2977 Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
2978 untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
2979
2980 You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
2981 handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
2982
2983 @findex EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
2984 @item EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
2985 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
2986 to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
2987 return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
2988
2989 Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
2990 return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
2991 address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
2992 the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
2993 frame. @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already been assigned,
2994 so it may be used to calculate the location of the target call frame.
2995
2996 Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
2997 address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
2998 the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
2999
3000 If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3001 define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3002
3003 @findex ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT
3004 @item ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT(@var{code}, @var{global})
3005 This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3006 handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3007 that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3008 and so may be read-only.
3009
3010 @var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3011 @var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3012 The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3013 as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3014
3015 If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3016 represented directly.
3017
3018 @findex ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX
3019 @item ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX(@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3020 This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3021 to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3022 Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3023 be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3024
3025 This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3026 handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3027 of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3028 to be emitted.
3029
3030 @findex MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR
3031 @item MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR(@var{context}, @var{fs}, @var{success})
3032 This macro allows the target to add cpu and operating system specific
3033 code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3034 available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3035 through signal frames.
3036
3037 This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in @file{unwind-dw2.c}
3038 and @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3039 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3040 for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3041 the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register save
3042 addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should branch to
3043 @var{success}. If the frame cannot be decoded, the macro should do
3044 nothing.
3045 @end table
3046
3047 @node Stack Checking
3048 @subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3049
3050 GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of
3051 the stack, if the @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of three ways:
3052
3053 @enumerate
3054 @item
3055 If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3056 will assume that you have arranged for stack checking to be done at
3057 appropriate places in the configuration files, e.g., in
3058 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}. GCC will do not other special
3059 processing.
3060
3061 @item
3062 If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and you defined a named pattern
3063 called @code{check_stack} in your @file{md} file, GCC will call that
3064 pattern with one argument which is the address to compare the stack
3065 value against. You must arrange for this pattern to report an error if
3066 the stack pointer is out of range.
3067
3068 @item
3069 If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3070 ``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3071 @end enumerate
3072
3073 Normally, you will use the default values of these macros, so GCC
3074 will use the third approach.
3075
3076 @table @code
3077 @findex STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3078 @item STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3079 A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3080 machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3081 is require by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to have to stack
3082 checking in some more efficient way than GCC's portable approach.
3083 The default value of this macro is zero.
3084
3085 @findex STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL
3086 @item STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL
3087 An integer representing the interval at which GCC must generate stack
3088 probe instructions. You will normally define this macro to be no larger
3089 than the size of the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The
3090 default value of 4096 is suitable for most systems.
3091
3092 @findex STACK_CHECK_PROBE_LOAD
3093 @item STACK_CHECK_PROBE_LOAD
3094 A integer which is nonzero if GCC should perform the stack probe
3095 as a load instruction and zero if GCC should use a store instruction.
3096 The default is zero, which is the most efficient choice on most systems.
3097
3098 @findex STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3099 @item STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3100 The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow,
3101 for languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of
3102 75 words should be adequate for most machines.
3103
3104 @findex STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3105 @item STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3106 The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3107 instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3108 stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3109 checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3110 default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3111 systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3112
3113 @findex STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3114 @item STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3115 GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3116 represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3117 space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3118 You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3119 use the default of four words.
3120
3121 @findex STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3122 @item STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3123 The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3124 fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3125 @option{-fstack-check}.
3126 GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3127 normally not need to override that default.
3128 @end table
3129
3130 @need 2000
3131 @node Frame Registers
3132 @subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3133
3134 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3135 This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3136
3137 @table @code
3138 @findex STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3139 @item STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3140 The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3141 fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3142 the hardware determines which register this is.
3143
3144 @findex FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3145 @item FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3146 The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3147 access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3148 hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3149 choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3150
3151 @findex HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3152 @item HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3153 On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3154 offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3155 allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3156 between these two locations). On those machines, define
3157 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3158 be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3159 @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3160 used for the frame pointer.
3161
3162 You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3163 is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3164 the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3165 completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3166 definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3167 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3168 or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3169
3170 Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3171 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3172
3173 @findex ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3174 @item ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3175 The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3176 the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3177 frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3178 register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3179 wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3180 pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3181 @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3182 (@pxref{Elimination}).
3183
3184 @findex RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3185 @item RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3186 The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3187 access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3188 machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3189 pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3190 to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3191 @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3192
3193 Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3194 address from the stack.
3195
3196 @findex STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3197 @findex STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3198 @item STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3199 @itemx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3200 Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3201 register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3202 function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3203 number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3204 these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3205 not be defined.
3206
3207 The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3208
3209 If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3210 defined; instead, the next two macros should be defined.
3211
3212 @findex STATIC_CHAIN
3213 @findex STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING
3214 @item STATIC_CHAIN
3215 @itemx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING
3216 If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros provide rtx giving
3217 @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3218 @code{STATIC_CHAIN} and @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING} give the locations
3219 as seen by the calling and called functions, respectively. Often the former
3220 will be at an offset from the stack pointer and the latter at an offset from
3221 the frame pointer.
3222
3223 @findex stack_pointer_rtx
3224 @findex frame_pointer_rtx
3225 @findex arg_pointer_rtx
3226 The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3227 @code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized prior to the use of these
3228 macros and should be used to refer to those items.
3229
3230 If the static chain is passed in a register, the two previous macros should
3231 be defined instead.
3232
3233 @findex DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3234 @item DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3235 This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3236 saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3237 DWARF2 exception handling.
3238
3239 Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3240 exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3241 extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3242 in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3243 used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3244 routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3245 registers that are not call-saved.
3246
3247 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3248 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3249
3250 @findex PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3251 @item PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3252
3253 This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3254 for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3255
3256 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3257 @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3258
3259 @end table
3260
3261 @node Elimination
3262 @subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3263
3264 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3265 This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3266
3267 @table @code
3268 @findex FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
3269 @item FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
3270 A C expression which is nonzero if a function must have and use a frame
3271 pointer. This expression is evaluated in the reload pass. If its value is
3272 nonzero the function will have a frame pointer.
3273
3274 The expression can in principle examine the current function and decide
3275 according to the facts, but on most machines the constant 0 or the
3276 constant 1 suffices. Use 0 when the machine allows code to be generated
3277 with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space. Use 1
3278 when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame pointer.
3279
3280 In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3281 without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3282 automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3283 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} says. You don't need to worry about
3284 them.
3285
3286 In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3287 register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3288 fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3289
3290 @findex INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET
3291 @findex get_frame_size
3292 @item INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3293 A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3294 between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3295 the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
3296 such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3297 registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3298
3299 If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3300 need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3301 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} is defined to always be true; in that
3302 case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3303
3304 @findex ELIMINABLE_REGS
3305 @item ELIMINABLE_REGS
3306 If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3307 eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3308 defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3309 references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3310
3311 The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3312 of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3313
3314 On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3315 the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3316 must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3317 replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3318 depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3319
3320 In this case, you might specify:
3321 @example
3322 #define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3323 @{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3324 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3325 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3326 @end example
3327
3328 Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3329 specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3330
3331 @findex CAN_ELIMINATE
3332 @item CAN_ELIMINATE (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg})
3333 A C expression that returns nonzero if the compiler is allowed to try
3334 to replace register number @var{from-reg} with register number
3335 @var{to-reg}. This macro need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3336 is defined, and will usually be the constant 1, since most of the cases
3337 preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3338 knows about.
3339
3340 @findex INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET
3341 @item INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3342 This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3343 specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3344 registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3345 defined.
3346 @end table
3347
3348 @node Stack Arguments
3349 @subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3350 @cindex arguments on stack
3351 @cindex stack arguments
3352
3353 The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3354 on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3355 control passing certain arguments in registers.
3356
3357 @table @code
3358 @findex PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
3359 @item PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
3360 A C expression whose value is nonzero if an argument declared in
3361 a prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should
3362 actually be passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding
3363 errors in certain cases of mismatch, it also makes for better
3364 code on certain machines. If the macro is not defined in target
3365 header files, it defaults to 0.
3366
3367 @findex PUSH_ARGS
3368 @item PUSH_ARGS
3369 A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3370 outgoing arguments.
3371 If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3372 That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3373 allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3374 it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3375
3376 @findex PUSH_ROUNDING
3377 @item PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3378 A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3379 stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3380
3381 On some machines, the definition
3382
3383 @example
3384 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3385 @end example
3386
3387 @noindent
3388 will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3389 to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3390 alignment. Then the definition should be
3391
3392 @example
3393 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3394 @end example
3395
3396 @findex ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3397 @findex current_function_outgoing_args_size
3398 @item ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3399 A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3400 will be computed and placed into the variable
3401 @code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3402 onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3403 increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3404
3405 Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3406 is not proper.
3407
3408 @findex REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3409 @item REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3410 Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3411 allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3412 registers.
3413
3414 The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3415 arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3416 which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3417
3418 This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3419 machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3420 which.
3421 @c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3422 @c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3423
3424 @findex MAYBE_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3425 @findex FINAL_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3426 @item MAYBE_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3427 @itemx FINAL_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{const_size}, @var{var_size})
3428 Define these macros in addition to the one above if functions might
3429 allocate stack space for arguments even when their values are passed
3430 in registers. These should be used when the stack space allocated
3431 for arguments in registers is not a simple constant independent of the
3432 function declaration.
3433
3434 The value of the first macro is the size, in bytes, of the area that
3435 we should initially assume would be reserved for arguments passed in registers.
3436
3437 The value of the second macro is the actual size, in bytes, of the area
3438 that will be reserved for arguments passed in registers. This takes two
3439 arguments: an integer representing the number of bytes of fixed sized
3440 arguments on the stack, and a tree representing the number of bytes of
3441 variable sized arguments on the stack.
3442
3443 When these macros are defined, @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} will only be
3444 called for libcall functions, the current function, or for a function
3445 being called when it is known that such stack space must be allocated.
3446 In each case this value can be easily computed.
3447
3448 When deciding whether a called function needs such stack space, and how
3449 much space to reserve, GCC uses these two macros instead of
3450 @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}.
3451
3452 @findex OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3453 @item OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE
3454 Define this if it is the responsibility of the caller to allocate the area
3455 reserved for arguments passed in registers.
3456
3457 If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3458 whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3459 @code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.
3460
3461 @findex STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3462 @item STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3463 Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3464 stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3465 @c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3466 @c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3467
3468 Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3469 stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3470 suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3471 stack in its natural location.
3472
3473 @findex RETURN_POPS_ARGS
3474 @item RETURN_POPS_ARGS (@var{fundecl}, @var{funtype}, @var{stack-size})
3475 A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes of its own
3476 arguments that a function pops on returning, or 0 if the
3477 function pops no arguments and the caller must therefore pop them all
3478 after the function returns.
3479
3480 @var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3481 the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3482 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3483 From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3484
3485 @var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3486 describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3487 @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3488 From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3489 arguments (if known).
3490
3491 When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3492 will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3493 you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3494 by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3495 a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3496 in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3497
3498 @var{stack-size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
3499 stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3500 argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3501
3502 On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
3503 of this macro is @var{stack-size}. On the 68000, using the standard
3504 calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3505 the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3506 convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3507 arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3508 nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3509 @var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3510 number of arguments.
3511
3512 @findex CALL_POPS_ARGS
3513 @item CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3514 A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3515 pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3516 when compiling a function call.
3517
3518 @var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3519 have been accumulated.
3520
3521 On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3522 that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3523 that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
3524 call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3525 appropriate.
3526
3527 @end table
3528
3529 @node Register Arguments
3530 @subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3531 @cindex arguments in registers
3532 @cindex registers arguments
3533
3534 This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3535 types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3536 the stack.
3537
3538 @table @code
3539 @findex FUNCTION_ARG
3540 @item FUNCTION_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3541 A C expression that controls whether a function argument is passed
3542 in a register, and which register.
3543
3544 The arguments are @var{cum}, which summarizes all the previous
3545 arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
3546 the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
3547 (which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
3548 which is 1 for an ordinary argument and 0 for nameless arguments that
3549 correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called function's prototype.
3550 @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a syntax error has previously
3551 occurred.
3552
3553 The value of the expression is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the
3554 hard register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the
3555 argument on the stack.
3556
3557 For machines like the VAX and 68000, where normally all arguments are
3558 pushed, zero suffices as a definition.
3559
3560 The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
3561 used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
3562 of the @code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
3563 @code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
3564 describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
3565 @code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3566 register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
3567 register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
3568 second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
3569 the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
3570 As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
3571 RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
3572 argument is also stored on the stack.
3573
3574 The last time this macro is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
3575 VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
3576 pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
3577
3578 @cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
3579 The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a machine
3580 where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to cause
3581 nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is done
3582 by making @code{FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever @var{named} is 0.
3583
3584 @cindex @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
3585 @cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
3586 You may use the macro @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (@var{mode}, @var{type})}
3587 in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
3588 type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
3589 is not defined and @code{FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
3590 argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
3591 defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
3592 a register.
3593
3594 @findex MUST_PASS_IN_STACK
3595 @item MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (@var{mode}, @var{type})
3596 Define as a C expression that evaluates to nonzero if we do not know how
3597 to pass TYPE solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
3598 definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
3599 documentation.
3600
3601 @findex FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG
3602 @item FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3603 Define this macro if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
3604 that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
3605 necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
3606 argument.
3607
3608 For such machines, @code{FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in which
3609 the caller passes the value, and @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should
3610 be defined in a similar fashion to tell the function being called
3611 where the arguments will arrive.
3612
3613 If @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined, @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
3614 serves both purposes.
3615
3616 @findex FUNCTION_ARG_PARTIAL_NREGS
3617 @item FUNCTION_ARG_PARTIAL_NREGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3618 A C expression for the number of words, at the beginning of an
3619 argument, that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
3620 arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
3621 pushed on the stack.
3622
3623 On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
3624 registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
3625 first @var{n} words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
3626 on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
3627 structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
3628 in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
3629 compiler when this occurs, and how many of the words should go in
3630 registers.
3631
3632 @code{FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
3633 register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
3634 @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
3635
3636 @findex FUNCTION_ARG_PASS_BY_REFERENCE
3637 @item FUNCTION_ARG_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3638 A C expression that indicates when an argument must be passed by reference.
3639 If nonzero for an argument, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
3640 pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
3641 The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
3642 to that type.
3643
3644 On machines where @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is not defined, a suitable
3645 definition of this macro might be
3646 @smallexample
3647 #define FUNCTION_ARG_PASS_BY_REFERENCE\
3648 (CUM, MODE, TYPE, NAMED) \
3649 MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (MODE, TYPE)
3650 @end smallexample
3651 @c this is *still* too long. --mew 5feb93
3652
3653 @findex FUNCTION_ARG_CALLEE_COPIES
3654 @item FUNCTION_ARG_CALLEE_COPIES (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3655 If defined, a C expression that indicates when it is the called function's
3656 responsibility to make a copy of arguments passed by invisible reference.
3657 Normally, the caller makes a copy and passes the address of the copy to the
3658 routine being called. When @code{FUNCTION_ARG_CALLEE_COPIES} is defined and is
3659 nonzero, the caller does not make a copy. Instead, it passes a pointer to the
3660 ``live'' value. The called function must not modify this value. If it can be
3661 determined that the value won't be modified, it need not make a copy;
3662 otherwise a copy must be made.
3663
3664 @findex CUMULATIVE_ARGS
3665 @item CUMULATIVE_ARGS
3666 A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument of
3667 @code{FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some target machines,
3668 the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number of bytes of
3669 argument so far.
3670
3671 There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
3672 arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
3673 variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
3674 arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
3675 @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
3676 should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
3677
3678 @findex INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS
3679 @item INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname},
3680 @var{fndecl}) A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
3681 @var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The variable
3682 has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype} is the tree node
3683 for the data type of the function which will receive the args, or 0 if the args
3684 are to a compiler support library function. For direct calls that are not
3685 libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the declaration node of the function.
3686 @var{fndecl} is also set when @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find
3687 arguments for the function being compiled.
3688
3689 When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
3690 @var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
3691 contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
3692 an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
3693 macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
3694 never both of them at once.
3695
3696 @findex INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS
3697 @item INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
3698 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
3699 it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
3700 @code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
3701 is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
3702 0)} is used instead.
3703
3704 @findex INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS
3705 @item INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
3706 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
3707 finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
3708 undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
3709
3710 The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
3711 with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
3712 argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
3713 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
3714 @c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
3715 @c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
3716
3717 @findex FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE
3718 @item FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3719 A C statement (sans semicolon) to update the summarizer variable
3720 @var{cum} to advance past an argument in the argument list. The
3721 values @var{mode}, @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument.
3722 Once this is done, the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing
3723 the @emph{following} argument with @code{FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
3724
3725 This macro need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
3726 on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
3727 used for arguments without any special help.
3728
3729 @findex FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING
3730 @item FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
3731 If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
3732 to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
3733 @code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
3734 @code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
3735
3736 The @emph{amount} of padding is always just enough to reach the next
3737 multiple of @code{FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY}; this macro does not control
3738 it.
3739
3740 This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
3741 For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
3742 big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
3743 constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
3744
3745 @findex PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
3746 @item PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
3747 If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
3748 implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
3749 next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
3750 controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
3751 arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
3752
3753 @findex FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY
3754 @item FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (@var{mode}, @var{type})
3755 If defined, a C expression that gives the alignment boundary, in bits,
3756 of an argument with the specified mode and type. If it is not defined,
3757 @code{PARM_BOUNDARY} is used for all arguments.
3758
3759 @findex FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P
3760 @item FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
3761 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
3762 register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
3763 @emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
3764 the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
3765 used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
3766 stack.
3767
3768 @findex LOAD_ARGS_REVERSED
3769 @item LOAD_ARGS_REVERSED
3770 If defined, the order in which arguments are loaded into their
3771 respective argument registers is reversed so that the last
3772 argument is loaded first. This macro only affects arguments
3773 passed in registers.
3774
3775 @end table
3776
3777 @node Scalar Return
3778 @subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
3779 @cindex return values in registers
3780 @cindex values, returned by functions
3781 @cindex scalars, returned as values
3782
3783 This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
3784 values---values that can fit in registers.
3785
3786 @table @code
3787 @findex FUNCTION_VALUE
3788 @item FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
3789 A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a
3790 function returns a value of data type @var{valtype}. @var{valtype} is
3791 a tree node representing a data type. Write @code{TYPE_MODE
3792 (@var{valtype})} to get the machine mode used to represent that type.
3793 On many machines, only the mode is relevant. (Actually, on most
3794 machines, scalar values are returned in the same place regardless of
3795 mode).
3796
3797 The value of the expression is usually a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3798 register where the return value is stored. The value can also be a
3799 @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in multiple places. See
3800 @code{FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the @code{parallel} form.
3801
3802 If @code{PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} is defined, you must apply the same
3803 promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if @var{valtype} is a
3804 scalar type.
3805
3806 If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
3807 node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
3808 pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
3809 convention for specific functions when all their calls are
3810 known.
3811
3812 @code{FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return vales with aggregate data
3813 types, because these are returned in another way. See
3814 @code{STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM} and related macros, below.
3815
3816 @findex FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE
3817 @item FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
3818 Define this macro if the target machine has ``register windows''
3819 so that the register in which a function returns its value is not
3820 the same as the one in which the caller sees the value.
3821
3822 For such machines, @code{FUNCTION_VALUE} computes the register in which
3823 the caller will see the value. @code{FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE} should be
3824 defined in a similar fashion to tell the function where to put the
3825 value.
3826
3827 If @code{FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE} is not defined,
3828 @code{FUNCTION_VALUE} serves both purposes.
3829
3830 @code{FUNCTION_OUTGOING_VALUE} is not used for return vales with
3831 aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
3832 @code{STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM} and related macros, below.
3833
3834 @findex LIBCALL_VALUE
3835 @item LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
3836 A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
3837 function returns a value of mode @var{mode}. If the precise function
3838 being called is known, @var{func} is a tree node
3839 (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
3840 pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
3841 convention for specific functions when all their calls are
3842 known.
3843
3844 Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
3845 support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
3846 specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
3847 compiled.
3848
3849 The definition of @code{LIBRARY_VALUE} need not be concerned aggregate
3850 data types, because none of the library functions returns such types.
3851
3852 @findex FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P
3853 @item FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
3854 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
3855 register in which the values of called function may come back.
3856
3857 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
3858 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
3859 recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
3860 suffices:
3861
3862 @example
3863 #define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
3864 @end example
3865
3866 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
3867 function use different registers for the return value, this macro
3868 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
3869
3870 @findex APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
3871 @item APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
3872 Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
3873 need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
3874 saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
3875 @end table
3876
3877 @node Aggregate Return
3878 @subsection How Large Values Are Returned
3879 @cindex aggregates as return values
3880 @cindex large return values
3881 @cindex returning aggregate values
3882 @cindex structure value address
3883
3884 When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
3885 cases), the value is not returned according to @code{FUNCTION_VALUE}
3886 (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the caller passes the address of a
3887 block of memory in which the value should be stored. This address
3888 is called the @dfn{structure value address}.
3889
3890 This section describes how to control returning structure values in
3891 memory.
3892
3893 @table @code
3894 @findex RETURN_IN_MEMORY
3895 @item RETURN_IN_MEMORY (@var{type})
3896 A C expression which can inhibit the returning of certain function
3897 values in registers, based on the type of value. A nonzero value says
3898 to return the function value in memory, just as large structures are
3899 always returned. Here @var{type} will be a C expression of type
3900 @code{tree}, representing the data type of the value.
3901
3902 Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
3903 by this macro. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
3904 takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
3905 possible to leave the macro undefined; this causes a default
3906 definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
3907 values, and 0 otherwise.
3908
3909 Do not use this macro to indicate that structures and unions should always
3910 be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
3911 to indicate this.
3912
3913 @findex DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
3914 @item DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
3915 Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
3916 in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
3917 only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
3918 If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
3919 and union return values are decided by the @code{RETURN_IN_MEMORY} macro.
3920
3921 If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
3922
3923 @findex STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM
3924 @item STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM
3925 If the structure value address is passed in a register, then
3926 @code{STRUCT_VALUE_REGNUM} should be the number of that register.
3927
3928 @findex STRUCT_VALUE
3929 @item STRUCT_VALUE
3930 If the structure value address is not passed in a register, define
3931 @code{STRUCT_VALUE} as an expression returning an RTX for the place
3932 where the address is passed. If it returns 0, the address is passed as
3933 an ``invisible'' first argument.
3934
3935 @findex STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING_REGNUM
3936 @item STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING_REGNUM
3937 On some architectures the place where the structure value address
3938 is found by the called function is not the same place that the
3939 caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
3940 be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
3941
3942 If the incoming location of the structure value address is in a
3943 register, define this macro as the register number.
3944
3945 @findex STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING
3946 @item STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING
3947 If the incoming location is not a register, then you should define
3948 @code{STRUCT_VALUE_INCOMING} as an expression for an RTX for where the
3949 called function should find the value. If it should find the value on
3950 the stack, define this to create a @code{mem} which refers to the frame
3951 pointer. A definition of 0 means that the address is passed as an
3952 ``invisible'' first argument.
3953
3954 @findex PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
3955 @item PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
3956 Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
3957 for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
3958 the address of a static variable containing the value.
3959
3960 Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
3961 pass an address to the subroutine.
3962
3963 This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
3964 nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
3965 @end table
3966
3967 @node Caller Saves
3968 @subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
3969
3970 If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
3971 makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
3972 must live across calls.
3973
3974 @table @code
3975 @findex DEFAULT_CALLER_SAVES
3976 @item DEFAULT_CALLER_SAVES
3977 Define this macro if function calls on the target machine do not preserve
3978 any registers; in other words, if @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} has 1
3979 for all registers. When defined, this macro enables @option{-fcaller-saves}
3980 by default for all optimization levels. It has no effect for optimization
3981 levels 2 and higher, where @option{-fcaller-saves} is the default.
3982
3983 @findex CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE
3984 @item CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
3985 A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
3986 a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
3987 restoring it around each function call. The expression should be 1 when
3988 this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
3989
3990 If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
3991 machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
3992
3993 @findex HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE
3994 @item HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
3995 A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
3996 of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
3997 @var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
3998 returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
3999 will select the smallest suitable mode.
4000 @end table
4001
4002 @node Function Entry
4003 @subsection Function Entry and Exit
4004 @cindex function entry and exit
4005 @cindex prologue
4006 @cindex epilogue
4007
4008 This section describes the macros that output function entry
4009 (@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4010
4011 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4012 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4013 function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4014 initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4015 saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4016 local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4017 stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4018
4019 The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4020 macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4021
4022 @findex regs_ever_live
4023 To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4024 @code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4025 @var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4026 prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4027 call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4028 @code{regs_ever_live}.)
4029
4030 On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4031 not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4032 they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4033 appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4034 registers are used in the function.
4035
4036 @findex frame_pointer_needed
4037 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4038 function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4039 pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4040 frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4041 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4042 time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4043
4044 The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4045 required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4046 listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4047 order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4048 stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4049 the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4050 for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4051 compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4052 or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4053 need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4054 @end deftypefn
4055
4056 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4057 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4058 prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4059 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4060 emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4061 @end deftypefn
4062
4063 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4064 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4065 epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4066 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4067 emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4068 @end deftypefn
4069
4070 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4071 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4072 function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4073 registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4074 called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4075 same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4076 registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4077 @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4078
4079 On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4080 of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4081 instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4082 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4083
4084 Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4085 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4086 switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4087 define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4088 target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4089 condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4090
4091 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4092 function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4093 two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4094 is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4095 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4096 a function that needs a frame pointer.
4097
4098 Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4099 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4100 The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4101 function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4102
4103 On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4104 others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4105 given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4106 number of arguments.
4107
4108 @findex current_function_pops_args
4109 Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4110 functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4111 needs to know what was decided. The variable that is called
4112 @code{current_function_pops_args} is the number of bytes of its
4113 arguments that a function should pop. @xref{Scalar Return}.
4114 @c what is the "its arguments" in the above sentence referring to, pray
4115 @c tell? --mew 5feb93
4116 @end deftypefn
4117
4118 @table @code
4119
4120 @itemize @bullet
4121 @item
4122 @findex current_function_pretend_args_size
4123 A region of @code{current_function_pretend_args_size} bytes of
4124 uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4125 stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4126 if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4127 arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4128 yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4129 region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4130 registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4131 features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4132
4133 @item
4134 An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4135 The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4136 the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4137 machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4138 in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4139 a save area.
4140
4141 @item
4142 A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4143 boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4144 this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4145 save area closer to the top of the stack.
4146
4147 @item
4148 @cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4149 Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4150 @code{current_function_outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4151 argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4152 @end itemize
4153
4154 Normally, it is necessary for the macros
4155 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4156 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to treat leaf functions specially.
4157 The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4158 function.
4159
4160 @findex EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4161 @item EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4162 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4163 instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4164 pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4165 adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function.
4166
4167 Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4168 frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4169 stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4170 compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4171
4172 @findex EPILOGUE_USES
4173 @item EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4174 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4175 used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
4176 pointer registers are already be assumed to be used as needed.
4177
4178 @findex EH_USES
4179 @item EH_USES (@var{regno})
4180 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4181 used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4182 on entry to an exception edge.
4183
4184 @findex DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
4185 @item DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
4186 Define this macro if the function epilogue contains delay slots to which
4187 instructions from the rest of the function can be ``moved''. The
4188 definition should be a C expression whose value is an integer
4189 representing the number of delay slots there.
4190
4191 @findex ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY
4192 @item ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY (@var{insn}, @var{n})
4193 A C expression that returns 1 if @var{insn} can be placed in delay
4194 slot number @var{n} of the epilogue.
4195
4196 The argument @var{n} is an integer which identifies the delay slot now
4197 being considered (since different slots may have different rules of
4198 eligibility). It is never negative and is always less than the number
4199 of epilogue delay slots (what @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE} returns).
4200 If you reject a particular insn for a given delay slot, in principle, it
4201 may be reconsidered for a subsequent delay slot. Also, other insns may
4202 (at least in principle) be considered for the so far unfilled delay
4203 slot.
4204
4205 @findex current_function_epilogue_delay_list
4206 @findex final_scan_insn
4207 The insns accepted to fill the epilogue delay slots are put in an RTL
4208 list made with @code{insn_list} objects, stored in the variable
4209 @code{current_function_epilogue_delay_list}. The insn for the first
4210 delay slot comes first in the list. Your definition of the macro
4211 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} should fill the delay slots by
4212 outputting the insns in this list, usually by calling
4213 @code{final_scan_insn}.
4214
4215 You need not define this macro if you did not define
4216 @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE}.
4217
4218 @end table
4219
4220 @findex TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4221 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, tree @var{function})
4222 A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4223 function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4224 inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4225 adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4226 the real function.
4227
4228 First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4229 contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4230 contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4231 in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4232 e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
4233 all other incoming arguments.
4234
4235 After the addition, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4236 @code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4237 not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4238 return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4239
4240 The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4241 the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
4242 of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4243 and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4244
4245 The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4246 have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4247 some targets, but probably not.
4248
4249 If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4250 front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4251 @var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4252 not support varargs.
4253 @end deftypefn
4254
4255 @findex TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_VCALL_THUNK
4256 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_VCALL_THUNK (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, int @var{vcall_offset}, tree @var{function})
4257 A function like @code{TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK}, except that if
4258 @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be made
4259 after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4260 adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4261
4262 @example
4263 p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4264 @end example
4265
4266 @noindent
4267 If this function is defined, it will always be used in place of
4268 @code{TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK}.
4269
4270 @end deftypefn
4271
4272 @node Profiling
4273 @subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4274 @cindex profiling, code generation
4275
4276 These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4277
4278 @table @code
4279 @findex FUNCTION_PROFILER
4280 @item FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4281 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4282 assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4283
4284 @findex mcount
4285 The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4286 your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
4287 compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4288 compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4289
4290 Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4291 variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4292 @samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4293 the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4294
4295 @findex PROFILE_HOOK
4296 @item PROFILE_HOOK
4297 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4298 code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4299 not support profiling.
4300
4301 @findex NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4302 @item NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4303 Define this macro if the @code{mcount} subroutine on your system does
4304 not need a counter variable allocated for each function. This is true
4305 for almost all modern implementations. If you define this macro, you
4306 must not use the @var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4307
4308 @findex PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4309 @item PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4310 Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4311 the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4312 @end table
4313
4314 @node Tail Calls
4315 @subsection Permitting tail calls
4316 @cindex tail calls
4317
4318 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{exp})
4319 True if it is ok to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4320 call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4321 or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4322
4323 It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4324 tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4325 during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4326 as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4327 ``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4328 may vary greatly between different architectures.
4329 @end deftypefn
4330
4331 @node Varargs
4332 @section Implementing the Varargs Macros
4333 @cindex varargs implementation
4334
4335 GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4336 @code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
4337 on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
4338 varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4339 conditionals to include it.
4340
4341 ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
4342 the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
4343 implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
4344 to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
4345 @code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
4346 supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
4347
4348 However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
4349 the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
4350 below.
4351
4352 @table @code
4353 @findex __builtin_saveregs
4354 @item __builtin_saveregs ()
4355 Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
4356 that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
4357 versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
4358 you use @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
4359
4360 On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
4361 control of the macro @code{EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On other machines,
4362 it calls a routine written in assembler language, found in
4363 @file{libgcc2.c}.
4364
4365 Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
4366 beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
4367 @code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
4368 This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
4369 to use them for its own purposes.
4370 @c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
4371 @c 10feb93
4372
4373 @findex __builtin_args_info
4374 @item __builtin_args_info (@var{category})
4375 Use this built-in function to find the first anonymous arguments in
4376 registers.
4377
4378 In general, a machine may have several categories of registers used for
4379 arguments, each for a particular category of data types. (For example,
4380 on some machines, floating-point registers are used for floating-point
4381 arguments while other arguments are passed in the general registers.)
4382 To make non-varargs functions use the proper calling convention, you
4383 have defined the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data type to record how many
4384 registers in each category have been used so far
4385
4386 @code{__builtin_args_info} accesses the same data structure of type
4387 @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} after the ordinary argument layout is finished
4388 with it, with @var{category} specifying which word to access. Thus, the
4389 value indicates the first unused register in a given category.
4390
4391 Normally, you would use @code{__builtin_args_info} in the implementation
4392 of @code{va_start}, accessing each category just once and storing the
4393 value in the @code{va_list} object. This is because @code{va_list} will
4394 have to update the values, and there is no way to alter the
4395 values accessed by @code{__builtin_args_info}.
4396
4397 @findex __builtin_next_arg
4398 @item __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
4399 This is the equivalent of @code{__builtin_args_info}, for stack
4400 arguments. It returns the address of the first anonymous stack
4401 argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
4402 returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
4403 argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
4404 fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
4405 verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
4406 of the current function.
4407
4408 @findex __builtin_classify_type
4409 @item __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
4410 Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
4411 passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
4412 has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
4413 specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
4414 with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
4415
4416 @code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
4417 considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
4418 kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
4419
4420 The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
4421 interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
4422 @end table
4423
4424 These machine description macros help implement varargs:
4425
4426 @table @code
4427 @findex EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS
4428 @item EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS ()
4429 If defined, is a C expression that produces the machine-specific code
4430 for a call to @code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the
4431 very beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made.
4432 The return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the
4433 value to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
4434
4435 @findex SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS
4436 @item SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (@var{args_so_far}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{pretend_args_size}, @var{second_time})
4437 This macro offers an alternative to using @code{__builtin_saveregs} and
4438 defining the macro @code{EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the
4439 anonymous register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments
4440 appear to have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is
4441 done, you can use the standard implementation of varargs that works for
4442 machines that pass all their arguments on the stack.
4443
4444 The argument @var{args_so_far} is the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
4445 structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
4446 named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
4447 last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
4448
4449 The macro implementation should do two things: first, push onto the
4450 stack all the argument registers @emph{not} used for the named
4451 arguments, and second, store the size of the data thus pushed into the
4452 @code{int}-valued variable whose name is supplied as the argument
4453 @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you store here will serve as
4454 additional offset for setting up the stack frame.
4455
4456 Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
4457 compile time without knowing their data types,
4458 @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that have just
4459 a single category of argument register and use it uniformly for all data
4460 types.
4461
4462 If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
4463 arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
4464 happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
4465 end of the source file. The macro @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
4466 not generate any instructions in this case.
4467
4468 @findex STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING
4469 @item STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING
4470 Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the location where a function
4471 argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
4472
4473 This macro controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
4474 is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this macro returns a
4475 nonzero value, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
4476 arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns a value of
4477 zero, but @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is defined, then all arguments
4478 are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments except the last
4479 are treated as named.
4480
4481 You need not define this macro if it always returns zero.
4482
4483 @findex PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED
4484 @item PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED
4485 If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
4486 @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
4487 @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
4488 defined, then define this macro to return nonzero if
4489 @code{SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, zero otherwise.
4490 Otherwise, you should not define this macro.
4491 @end table
4492
4493 @node Trampolines
4494 @section Trampolines for Nested Functions
4495 @cindex trampolines for nested functions
4496 @cindex nested functions, trampolines for
4497
4498 A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
4499 when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
4500 the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
4501 tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
4502 trampoline.
4503
4504 The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
4505 address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
4506 the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
4507 two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
4508 exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
4509 machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
4510 two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
4511 operands.
4512
4513 The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
4514 parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
4515 immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
4516 simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
4517 proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
4518 may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
4519 separately.
4520
4521 @table @code
4522 @findex TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE
4523 @item TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE (@var{file})
4524 A C statement to output, on the stream @var{file}, assembler code for a
4525 block of data that contains the constant parts of a trampoline. This
4526 code should not include a label---the label is taken care of
4527 automatically.
4528
4529 If you do not define this macro, it means no template is needed
4530 for the target. Do not define this macro on systems where the block move
4531 code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
4532 to generate it on the spot.
4533
4534 @findex TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
4535 @item TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
4536 The name of a subroutine to switch to the section in which the
4537 trampoline template is to be placed (@pxref{Sections}). The default is
4538 a value of @samp{readonly_data_section}, which places the trampoline in
4539 the section containing read-only data.
4540
4541 @findex TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
4542 @item TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
4543 A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
4544
4545 @findex TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
4546 @item TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
4547 Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
4548
4549 If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
4550 is used for aligning trampolines.
4551
4552 @findex INITIALIZE_TRAMPOLINE
4553 @item INITIALIZE_TRAMPOLINE (@var{addr}, @var{fnaddr}, @var{static_chain})
4554 A C statement to initialize the variable parts of a trampoline.
4555 @var{addr} is an RTX for the address of the trampoline; @var{fnaddr} is
4556 an RTX for the address of the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
4557 RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
4558 when it is called.
4559
4560 @findex TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS
4561 @item TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS (@var{addr})
4562 A C statement that should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
4563 the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address that
4564 was passed to @code{INITIALIZE_TRAMPOLINE}. In case the address to be
4565 used for a function call should be different from the address in which
4566 the template was stored, the different address should be assigned to
4567 @var{addr}. If this macro is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for
4568 function calls.
4569
4570 @findex ALLOCATE_TRAMPOLINE
4571 @item ALLOCATE_TRAMPOLINE (@var{fp})
4572 A C expression to allocate run-time space for a trampoline. The
4573 expression value should be an RTX representing a memory reference to the
4574 space for the trampoline.
4575
4576 @cindex @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} and trampolines
4577 @cindex @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and trampolines
4578 If this macro is not defined, by default the trampoline is allocated as
4579 a stack slot. This default is right for most machines. The exceptions
4580 are machines where it is impossible to execute instructions in the stack
4581 area. On such machines, you may have to implement a separate stack,
4582 using this macro in conjunction with @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4583 and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}.
4584
4585 @var{fp} points to a data structure, a @code{struct function}, which
4586 describes the compilation status of the immediate containing function of
4587 the function which the trampoline is for. Normally (when
4588 @code{ALLOCATE_TRAMPOLINE} is not defined), the stack slot for the
4589 trampoline is in the stack frame of this containing function. Other
4590 allocation strategies probably must do something analogous with this
4591 information.
4592 @end table
4593
4594 Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
4595 separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
4596 fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
4597 jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
4598
4599 Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
4600 the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
4601 make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
4602 subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
4603 latter makes initialization faster.
4604
4605 To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
4606 the following macros which describe the shape of the cache.
4607
4608 @table @code
4609 @findex INSN_CACHE_SIZE
4610 @item INSN_CACHE_SIZE
4611 The total size in bytes of the cache.
4612
4613 @findex INSN_CACHE_LINE_WIDTH
4614 @item INSN_CACHE_LINE_WIDTH
4615 The length in bytes of each cache line. The cache is divided into cache
4616 lines which are disjoint slots, each holding a contiguous chunk of data
4617 fetched from memory. Each time data is brought into the cache, an
4618 entire line is read at once. The data loaded into a cache line is
4619 always aligned on a boundary equal to the line size.
4620
4621 @findex INSN_CACHE_DEPTH
4622 @item INSN_CACHE_DEPTH
4623 The number of alternative cache lines that can hold any particular memory
4624 location.
4625 @end table
4626
4627 Alternatively, if the machine has system calls or instructions to clear
4628 the instruction cache directly, you can define the following macro.
4629
4630 @table @code
4631 @findex CLEAR_INSN_CACHE
4632 @item CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
4633 If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
4634 cache} in the specified interval. If it is not defined, and the macro
4635 @code{INSN_CACHE_SIZE} is defined, some generic code is generated to clear the
4636 cache. The definition of this macro would typically be a series of
4637 @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and @var{end} are both pointer
4638 expressions.
4639 @end table
4640
4641 To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
4642 you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
4643 cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
4644 beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
4645 its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
4646
4647 @table @code
4648 @findex TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
4649 @item TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
4650 Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
4651 work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
4652 which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
4653 @code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
4654
4655 If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
4656 C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
4657 special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
4658 statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
4659 global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
4660 special assembler code.
4661 @end table
4662
4663 @node Library Calls
4664 @section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
4665 @cindex library subroutine names
4666 @cindex @file{libgcc.a}
4667
4668 @c prevent bad page break with this line
4669 Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
4670
4671 @table @code
4672 @findex MULSI3_LIBCALL
4673 @item MULSI3_LIBCALL
4674 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4675 multiplication of one signed full-word by another. If you do not
4676 define this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__mulsi3},
4677 a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4678
4679 @findex DIVSI3_LIBCALL
4680 @item DIVSI3_LIBCALL
4681 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4682 division of one signed full-word by another. If you do not define
4683 this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__divsi3}, a
4684 function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4685
4686 @findex UDIVSI3_LIBCALL
4687 @item UDIVSI3_LIBCALL
4688 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4689 division of one unsigned full-word by another. If you do not define
4690 this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__udivsi3}, a
4691 function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4692
4693 @findex MODSI3_LIBCALL
4694 @item MODSI3_LIBCALL
4695 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for the
4696 remainder in division of one signed full-word by another. If you do
4697 not define this macro, the default name is used, which is
4698 @code{__modsi3}, a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4699
4700 @findex UMODSI3_LIBCALL
4701 @item UMODSI3_LIBCALL
4702 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for the
4703 remainder in division of one unsigned full-word by another. If you do
4704 not define this macro, the default name is used, which is
4705 @code{__umodsi3}, a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4706
4707 @findex MULDI3_LIBCALL
4708 @item MULDI3_LIBCALL
4709 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4710 multiplication of one signed double-word by another. If you do not
4711 define this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__muldi3},
4712 a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4713
4714 @findex DIVDI3_LIBCALL
4715 @item DIVDI3_LIBCALL
4716 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4717 division of one signed double-word by another. If you do not define
4718 this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__divdi3}, a
4719 function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4720
4721 @findex UDIVDI3_LIBCALL
4722 @item UDIVDI3_LIBCALL
4723 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for
4724 division of one unsigned full-word by another. If you do not define
4725 this macro, the default name is used, which is @code{__udivdi3}, a
4726 function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4727
4728 @findex MODDI3_LIBCALL
4729 @item MODDI3_LIBCALL
4730 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for the
4731 remainder in division of one signed double-word by another. If you do
4732 not define this macro, the default name is used, which is
4733 @code{__moddi3}, a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4734
4735 @findex UMODDI3_LIBCALL
4736 @item UMODDI3_LIBCALL
4737 A C string constant giving the name of the function to call for the
4738 remainder in division of one unsigned full-word by another. If you do
4739 not define this macro, the default name is used, which is
4740 @code{__umoddi3}, a function defined in @file{libgcc.a}.
4741
4742 @findex DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
4743 @item DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
4744 This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
4745 expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
4746 provide alternate names for gcc's internal library functions if there
4747 are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
4748
4749 @findex INIT_TARGET_OPTABS
4750 @item INIT_TARGET_OPTABS
4751 Define this macro as a C statement that declares additional library
4752 routines renames existing ones. @code{init_optabs} calls this macro after
4753 initializing all the normal library routines.
4754
4755 @findex FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
4756 @item FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL
4757 Define this macro as a C statement that returns nonzero if a call to
4758 the floating point comparison library function will return a boolean
4759 value that indicates the result of the comparison. It should return
4760 zero if one of gcc's own libgcc functions is called.
4761
4762 Most ports don't need to define this macro.
4763
4764 @findex TARGET_EDOM
4765 @cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
4766 @item TARGET_EDOM
4767 The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
4768 expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
4769 deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
4770 @file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
4771 system.
4772
4773 If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
4774 domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
4775 error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
4776 there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
4777 that @code{matherr} is used normally.
4778
4779 @findex GEN_ERRNO_RTX
4780 @cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
4781 @item GEN_ERRNO_RTX
4782 Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
4783 refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
4784 @code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
4785 macro, a reasonable default is used.
4786
4787 @findex TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS
4788 @cindex @code{bcopy}, implicit usage
4789 @cindex @code{memcpy}, implicit usage
4790 @cindex @code{memmove}, implicit usage
4791 @cindex @code{bzero}, implicit usage
4792 @cindex @code{memset}, implicit usage
4793 @item TARGET_MEM_FUNCTIONS
4794 Define this macro if GCC should generate calls to the ISO C
4795 (and System V) library functions @code{memcpy}, @code{memmove} and
4796 @code{memset} rather than the BSD functions @code{bcopy} and @code{bzero}.
4797
4798 @findex TARGET_C99_FUNCTIONS
4799 @cindex C99 math functions, implicit usage
4800 @item TARGET_C99_FUNCTIONS
4801 When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize @code{sin} calls into
4802 @code{sinf} and similarly for other functions defined by C99 standard. The
4803 default is nonzero that should be proper value for most modern systems, however
4804 number of existing systems lacks support for these functions in the runtime so
4805 they needs this macro to be redefined to 0.
4806
4807 @findex LIBGCC_NEEDS_DOUBLE
4808 @item LIBGCC_NEEDS_DOUBLE
4809 Define this macro if @code{float} arguments cannot be passed to library
4810 routines (so they must be converted to @code{double}). This macro
4811 affects both how library calls are generated and how the library
4812 routines in @file{libgcc.a} accept their arguments. It is useful on
4813 machines where floating and fixed point arguments are passed
4814 differently, such as the i860.
4815
4816 @findex NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
4817 @item NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
4818 Define this macro to generate code for Objective-C message sending using
4819 the calling convention of the NeXT system. This calling convention
4820 involves passing the object, the selector and the method arguments all
4821 at once to the method-lookup library function.
4822
4823 The default calling convention passes just the object and the selector
4824 to the lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
4825 @end table
4826
4827 @node Addressing Modes
4828 @section Addressing Modes
4829 @cindex addressing modes
4830
4831 @c prevent bad page break with this line
4832 This is about addressing modes.
4833
4834 @table @code
4835 @findex HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
4836 @findex HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
4837 @findex HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
4838 @findex HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
4839 @item HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
4840 @itemx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
4841 @itemx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
4842 @itemx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
4843 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
4844 pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
4845
4846 @findex HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
4847 @findex HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
4848 @item HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
4849 @itemx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
4850 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
4851 post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
4852 the size of the memory operand.
4853
4854 @findex HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
4855 @findex HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
4856 @item HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
4857 @itemx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
4858 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
4859 post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
4860
4861 @findex CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P
4862 @item CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
4863 A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
4864 is a valid address. On most machines, this can be defined as
4865 @code{CONSTANT_P (@var{x})}, but a few machines are more restrictive
4866 in which constant addresses are supported.
4867
4868 @findex CONSTANT_P
4869 @code{CONSTANT_P} accepts integer-values expressions whose values are
4870 not explicitly known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and
4871 @code{high} expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in
4872 addition to @code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
4873
4874 @findex MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
4875 @item MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
4876 A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
4877 memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
4878 the maximum number that @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} would ever
4879 accept.
4880
4881 @findex GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS
4882 @item GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
4883 A C compound statement with a conditional @code{goto @var{label};}
4884 executed if @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory address on the
4885 target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
4886
4887 It usually pays to define several simpler macros to serve as
4888 subroutines for this one. Otherwise it may be too complicated to
4889 understand.
4890
4891 This macro must exist in two variants: a strict variant and a
4892 non-strict one. The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It
4893 must be defined so that any pseudo-register that has not been
4894 allocated a hard register is considered a memory reference. In
4895 contexts where some kind of register is required, a pseudo-register
4896 with no hard register must be rejected.
4897
4898 The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
4899 accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
4900 register is required.
4901
4902 @findex REG_OK_STRICT
4903 Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
4904 macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
4905 @code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant
4906 in that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
4907
4908 Subroutines to check for acceptable registers for various purposes (one
4909 for base registers, one for index registers, and so on) are typically
4910 among the subroutines used to define @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}.
4911 Then only these subroutine macros need have two variants; the higher
4912 levels of macros may be the same whether strict or not.
4913
4914 Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
4915 and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
4916 constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
4917 specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
4918 recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
4919
4920 Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
4921 sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
4922 @code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
4923 naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
4924 be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
4925
4926 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
4927 On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
4928 the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
4929 target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
4930 into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
4931 @code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
4932 @code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
4933 Format}.
4934
4935 @findex saveable_obstack
4936 The best way to modify the name string is by adding text to the
4937 beginning, with suitable punctuation to prevent any ambiguity. Allocate
4938 the new name in @code{saveable_obstack}. You will have to modify
4939 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to remove and decode the added text and
4940 output the name accordingly, and define @code{TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING}
4941 to access the original name string.
4942
4943 You can check the information stored here into the @code{symbol_ref} in
4944 the definitions of the macros @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} and
4945 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
4946
4947 @findex REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P
4948 @item REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{x})
4949 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} (assumed to be a @code{reg}
4950 RTX) is valid for use as a base register. For hard registers, it
4951 should always accept those which the hardware permits and reject the
4952 others. Whether the macro accepts or rejects pseudo registers must be
4953 controlled by @code{REG_OK_STRICT} as described above. This usually
4954 requires two variant definitions, of which @code{REG_OK_STRICT}
4955 controls the one actually used.
4956
4957 @findex REG_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P
4958 @item REG_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{x}, @var{mode})
4959 A C expression that is just like @code{REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
4960 that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
4961 @var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
4962 reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
4963 you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
4964 @code{REG_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
4965
4966 @findex REG_OK_FOR_INDEX_P
4967 @item REG_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{x})
4968 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} (assumed to be a @code{reg}
4969 RTX) is valid for use as an index register.
4970
4971 The difference between an index register and a base register is that
4972 the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
4973 two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
4974 labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
4975 labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
4976 may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
4977 looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
4978 only if neither labeling works.
4979
4980 @findex FIND_BASE_TERM
4981 @item FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
4982 A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x}.
4983 This macro is used in only one place: `find_base_term' in alias.c.
4984
4985 It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
4986 that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
4987
4988 The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
4989 a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
4990
4991 @findex LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
4992 @item LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{oldx}, @var{mode}, @var{win})
4993 A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x} with a valid
4994 memory address for an operand of mode @var{mode}. @var{win} will be a
4995 C statement label elsewhere in the code; the macro definition may use
4996
4997 @example
4998 GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{win});
4999 @end example
5000
5001 @noindent
5002 to avoid further processing if the address has become legitimate.
5003
5004 @findex break_out_memory_refs
5005 @var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5006 and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5007 @var{x}.
5008
5009 The code generated by this macro should not alter the substructure of
5010 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5011 should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5012
5013 It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5014 address. The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In
5015 fact, it is safe for this macro to do nothing. But often a
5016 machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5017
5018 @findex LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS
5019 @item LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5020 A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5021 that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5022 @var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5023 It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5024 performance reasons.
5025
5026 For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5027 reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5028 registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5029 processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5030 needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
5031 @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5032 generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5033 be shared.
5034
5035 @emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5036 to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5037 and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5038 of reload internals.
5039
5040 @emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5041 previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5042 then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5043
5044 @findex push_reload
5045 The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5046 need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5047 suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5048
5049 The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5050 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5051 should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5052 This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5053 @code{push_reload}.
5054
5055 @findex strict_memory_address_p
5056 The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5057 the address has become legitimate.
5058
5059 @findex copy_rtx
5060 If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5061 this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that is unshares only a
5062 single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5063 top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5064 It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5065 address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5066
5067 @findex GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS
5068 @item GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS (@var{addr}, @var{label})
5069 A C statement or compound statement with a conditional @code{goto
5070 @var{label};} executed if memory address @var{x} (an RTX) can have
5071 different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5072 reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5073 but not others.
5074
5075 Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5076 effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5077 of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5078 addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5079
5080 You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5081
5082 @findex LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P
5083 @item LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5084 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for
5085 an immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5086 @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this. In fact,
5087 @samp{1} is a suitable definition for this macro on machines where
5088 anything @code{CONSTANT_P} is valid.
5089 @end table
5090
5091 @node Condition Code
5092 @section Condition Code Status
5093 @cindex condition code status
5094
5095 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5096 This describes the condition code status.
5097
5098 @findex cc_status
5099 The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5100 describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5101 the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
5102 variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5103 currently based, and several standard flags.
5104
5105 Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5106 description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
5107 information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5108
5109 @table @code
5110 @findex CC_STATUS_MDEP
5111 @item CC_STATUS_MDEP
5112 C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5113 component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
5114
5115 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5116
5117 @findex CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
5118 @item CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
5119 A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5120 The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5121 the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
5122 define this macro to initialize it.
5123
5124 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5125
5126 @findex NOTICE_UPDATE_CC
5127 @item NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
5128 A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5129 appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
5130 this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5131 code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5132 set @code{(cc0)}.
5133
5134 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5135
5136 If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5137 other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5138 invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5139 reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5140 registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5141 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5142 insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5143 based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5144 value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
5145 this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5146 @samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5147 @code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5148 condition code value.
5149
5150 The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5151 with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5152 @code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5153 constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
5154 insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
5155 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5156 @code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5157
5158 A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5159 that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5160 @samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5161 two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
5162
5163 @findex EXTRA_CC_MODES
5164 @item EXTRA_CC_MODES
5165 Condition codes are represented in registers by machine modes of class
5166 @code{MODE_CC}. By default, there is just one mode, @code{CCmode}, with
5167 this class. If you need more such modes, create a file named
5168 @file{@var{machine}-modes.def} in your @file{config/@var{machine}}
5169 directory (@pxref{Back End, , Anatomy of a Target Back End}), containing
5170 a list of these modes. Each entry in the list should be a call to the
5171 macro @code{CC}. This macro takes one argument, which is the name of
5172 the mode: it should begin with @samp{CC}. Do not put quotation marks
5173 around the name, or include the trailing @samp{mode}; these are
5174 automatically added. There should not be anything else in the file
5175 except comments.
5176
5177 A sample @file{@var{machine}-modes.def} file might look like this:
5178
5179 @smallexample
5180 CC (CC_NOOV) /* @r{Comparison only valid if there was no overflow.} */
5181 CC (CCFP) /* @r{Floating point comparison that cannot trap.} */
5182 CC (CCFPE) /* @r{Floating point comparison that may trap.} */
5183 @end smallexample
5184
5185 When you create this file, the macro @code{EXTRA_CC_MODES} is
5186 automatically defined by @command{configure}, with value @samp{1}.
5187
5188 @findex SELECT_CC_MODE
5189 @item SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
5190 Returns a mode from class @code{MODE_CC} to be used when comparison
5191 operation code @var{op} is applied to rtx @var{x} and @var{y}. For
5192 example, on the SPARC, @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} is defined as (see
5193 @pxref{Jump Patterns} for a description of the reason for this
5194 definition)
5195
5196 @smallexample
5197 #define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
5198 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
5199 ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode) \
5200 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
5201 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
5202 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
5203 @end smallexample
5204
5205 You need not define this macro if @code{EXTRA_CC_MODES} is not defined.
5206
5207 @findex CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON
5208 @item CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1})
5209 On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
5210 convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
5211 does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
5212 comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
5213
5214 On such machines, define this macro to be a C statement to do any
5215 required conversions. @var{code} is the initial comparison code
5216 and @var{op0} and @var{op1} are the left and right operands of the
5217 comparison, respectively. You should modify @var{code}, @var{op0}, and
5218 @var{op1} as required.
5219
5220 GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
5221 valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
5222 @file{md} file.
5223
5224 You need not define this macro if it would never change the comparison
5225 code or operands.
5226
5227 @findex REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE
5228 @item REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
5229 A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
5230 comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
5231 can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
5232 then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
5233
5234 You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
5235 floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
5236 For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
5237 inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
5238
5239 @smallexample
5240 #define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
5241 @end smallexample
5242
5243 @findex REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
5244 A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
5245 comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
5246 @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
5247 machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
5248 instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
5249 freely convert unordered compares to ordered one. Then definition may look
5250 like:
5251
5252 @smallexample
5253 #define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
5254 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
5255 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
5256 @end smallexample
5257
5258 @findex REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P
5259 @item REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (@var{code1}, @var{code2})
5260 A C expression that returns true if the conditional execution predicate
5261 @var{code1} is the inverse of @var{code2} and vice versa. Define this to
5262 return 0 if the target has conditional execution predicates that cannot be
5263 reversed safely. If no expansion is specified, this macro is defined as
5264 follows:
5265
5266 @smallexample
5267 #define REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (x, y) \
5268 ((x) == reverse_condition (y))
5269 @end smallexample
5270
5271 @end table
5272
5273 @node Costs
5274 @section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
5275 @cindex costs of instructions
5276 @cindex relative costs
5277 @cindex speed of instructions
5278
5279 These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
5280 on the target machine.
5281
5282 @table @code
5283 @findex REGISTER_MOVE_COST
5284 @item REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
5285 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
5286 register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
5287 expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
5288 value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
5289 that.
5290
5291 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
5292 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
5293 registers if they are not general registers.
5294
5295 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
5296 hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
5297 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
5298 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
5299 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
5300 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
5301
5302 @findex MEMORY_MOVE_COST
5303 @item MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
5304 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
5305 register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
5306 is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
5307 is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
5308 registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
5309 should define this macro to express the relative cost.
5310
5311 If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
5312 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
5313 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
5314 between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
5315 more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
5316 reflect the actual cost of the move.
5317
5318 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
5319 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
5320 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
5321 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
5322 4 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
5323 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
5324 are the same as to this macro.
5325
5326 @findex BRANCH_COST
5327 @item BRANCH_COST
5328 A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is
5329 the default; other values are interpreted relative to that.
5330 @end table
5331
5332 Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
5333 but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
5334 ordinarily expect.
5335
5336 @table @code
5337 @findex SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
5338 @item SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
5339 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
5340 than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
5341 faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
5342 require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
5343 between byte and (aligned) word loads.
5344
5345 When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
5346 finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
5347 load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
5348 faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
5349 may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
5350 other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
5351
5352 @findex SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS
5353 @item SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
5354 Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
5355 @var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
5356 than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
5357 handler.
5358
5359 When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
5360 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
5361 moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
5362 Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
5363 cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
5364
5365 If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
5366 this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
5367 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
5368
5369 @findex DONT_REDUCE_ADDR
5370 @item DONT_REDUCE_ADDR
5371 Define this macro to inhibit strength reduction of memory addresses.
5372 (On some machines, such strength reduction seems to do harm rather
5373 than good.)
5374
5375 @findex MOVE_RATIO
5376 @item MOVE_RATIO
5377 The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
5378 which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
5379 string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
5380 make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
5381
5382 Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
5383 @code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
5384 the number of such sequences.
5385
5386 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
5387
5388 @findex MOVE_BY_PIECES_P
5389 @item MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
5390 A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
5391 copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
5392 will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
5393 than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
5394
5395 @findex MOVE_MAX_PIECES
5396 @item MOVE_MAX_PIECES
5397 A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
5398 a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
5399
5400 @findex CLEAR_RATIO
5401 @item CLEAR_RATIO
5402 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
5403 of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
5404 or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
5405 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
5406
5407 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
5408
5409 @findex CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P
5410 @item CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
5411 A C expression used to determine whether @code{clear_by_pieces} will be used
5412 to clear a chunk of memory, or whether some other block clear mechanism
5413 will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
5414 than @code{CLEAR_RATIO}.
5415
5416 @findex STORE_BY_PIECES_P
5417 @item STORE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
5418 A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
5419 used to set a chunk of memory to a constant value, or whether some other
5420 mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_memset} when storing
5421 values other than constant zero and by @code{__builtin_strcpy} when
5422 when called with a constant source string.
5423 Defaults to @code{MOVE_BY_PIECES_P}.
5424
5425 @findex USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT
5426 @item USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
5427 A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
5428 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
5429 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
5430
5431 @findex USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT
5432 @item USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
5433 A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
5434 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
5435 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
5436
5437 @findex USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT
5438 @item USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
5439 A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
5440 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
5441 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
5442
5443 @findex USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT
5444 @item USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
5445 A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
5446 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
5447 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
5448
5449 @findex USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT
5450 @item USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
5451 A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
5452 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
5453 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
5454
5455 @findex USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT
5456 @item USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
5457 A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
5458 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
5459 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
5460
5461 @findex USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT
5462 @item USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
5463 This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
5464 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
5465 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
5466
5467 @findex USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT
5468 @item USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
5469 This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
5470 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
5471 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
5472
5473 @findex NO_FUNCTION_CSE
5474 @item NO_FUNCTION_CSE
5475 Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
5476 function address than to call an address kept in a register.
5477
5478 @findex NO_RECURSIVE_FUNCTION_CSE
5479 @item NO_RECURSIVE_FUNCTION_CSE
5480 Define this macro if it is as good or better for a function to call
5481 itself with an explicit address than to call an address kept in a
5482 register.
5483 @end table
5484
5485 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RTX_COSTS (rtx @var{x}, int @var{code}, int @var{outer_code}, int *@var{total})
5486 This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
5487
5488 The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
5489 available for examination in @var{x}, and the rtx code of the expression
5490 in which it is contained, found in @var{outer_code}. @var{code} is the
5491 expression code---redundant, since it can be obtained with
5492 @code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
5493
5494 In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
5495 @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
5496 instructions.
5497
5498 On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
5499 for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
5500 necessary.
5501
5502 The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
5503 processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
5504 @end deftypefn
5505
5506 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDRESS_COST (rtx @var{address})
5507 This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
5508 @var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
5509 the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
5510
5511 For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
5512 true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
5513 instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
5514 all addresses will have equal costs.
5515
5516 In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
5517 the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
5518 cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
5519
5520 For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
5521 and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
5522 is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
5523 references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
5524 the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
5525 that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
5526 instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
5527 specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
5528
5529 This hook is never called with an invalid address.
5530
5531 On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
5532 cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
5533 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
5534 be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
5535 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
5536 should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
5537 should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
5538 registers on machines with lots of registers.
5539 @end deftypefn
5540
5541 @node Scheduling
5542 @section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
5543
5544 The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
5545 adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
5546 hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
5547 them: try the first ones in this list first.
5548
5549 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE (void)
5550 This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
5551 issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
5552 Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
5553 an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
5554 constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
5555 hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
5556 This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
5557 it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
5558 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
5559
5560 For the automaton based pipeline interface, you could define this hook
5561 to return the value of the macro @code{MAX_DFA_ISSUE_RATE}.
5562 @end deftypefn
5563
5564 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx @var{insn}, int @var{more})
5565 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
5566 from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
5567 still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
5568 @samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
5569 @code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
5570 You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
5571 than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
5572 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
5573 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
5574 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
5575 was scheduled.
5576 @end deftypefn
5577
5578 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST (rtx @var{insn}, rtx @var{link}, rtx @var{dep_insn}, int @var{cost})
5579 This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
5580 relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
5581 dependence @var{link}. It should return the new value. The default
5582 is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example
5583 to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
5584 that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
5585 data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
5586 description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
5587 output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
5588 times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
5589 acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
5590 @pxref{Automaton pipeline description}.
5591 @end deftypefn
5592
5593 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY (rtx @var{insn}, int @var{priority})
5594 This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
5595 @var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Reduce the priority to
5596 execute @var{insn} earlier, increase the priority to execute @var{insn}
5597 later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
5598 scheduling priorities of insns.
5599 @end deftypefn
5600
5601 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
5602 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
5603 list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
5604 combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
5605 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
5606 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
5607 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
5608 list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
5609 a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
5610 reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
5611 @var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp}-1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
5612 is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
5613 the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
5614 can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
5615 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
5616 @end deftypefn
5617
5618 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2 (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx *@var{ready}, int *@var{n_ready}, @var{clock})
5619 Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
5620 function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
5621 is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
5622 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
5623 return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
5624 this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
5625 scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
5626 cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
5627 @end deftypefn
5628
5629 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK (rtx @var{head}, rtx @var{tail})
5630 This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
5631 chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
5632 correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
5633 example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
5634 analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
5635 dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
5636 calculated.
5637 @end deftypefn
5638
5639 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{max_ready})
5640 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
5641 instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
5642 pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
5643 is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
5644 @var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
5645 region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
5646 scratch space if it is needed, e.g. by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
5647 @end deftypefn
5648
5649 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
5650 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
5651 instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
5652 cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
5653 is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
5654 to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
5655 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
5656 @end deftypefn
5657
5658 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_USE_DFA_PIPELINE_INTERFACE (void)
5659 This hook is called many times during insn scheduling. If the hook
5660 returns nonzero, the automaton based pipeline description is used for
5661 insn scheduling. Otherwise the traditional pipeline description is
5662 used. The default is usage of the traditional pipeline description.
5663
5664 You should also remember that to simplify the insn scheduler sources
5665 an empty traditional pipeline description interface is generated even
5666 if there is no a traditional pipeline description in the @file{.md}
5667 file. The same is true for the automaton based pipeline description.
5668 That means that you should be accurate in defining the hook.
5669 @end deftypefn
5670
5671 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
5672 The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
5673 pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
5674 when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
5675 simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
5676 processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
5677 based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
5678 when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
5679 @end deftypefn
5680
5681 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
5682 The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
5683 @end deftypefn
5684
5685 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
5686 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
5687 to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
5688 simulated processor cycle finishes.
5689 @end deftypefn
5690
5691 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
5692 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
5693 used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
5694 @end deftypefn
5695
5696 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD (void)
5697 This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
5698 for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
5699 chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
5700 value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
5701 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
5702 subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
5703 maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
5704 @acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
5705 packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
5706 rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
5707
5708 This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
5709 processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
5710 with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
5711 @var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
5712 @var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
5713 processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
5714 @var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
5715 until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
5716 the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
5717
5718 Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
5719 pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
5720 schedules to choose the best one.
5721
5722 The default is no multipass scheduling.
5723 @end deftypefn
5724
5725 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD (rtx)
5726
5727 This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
5728 considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
5729 zero for insn passed as the parameter, the insn will be not chosen to
5730 be issued.
5731
5732 The default is that any ready insns can be choosen to be issued.
5733 @end deftypefn
5734
5735 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE (FILE *, int, rtx, int, int, int *)
5736
5737 This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing insn passed
5738 as the third parameter on given cycle. If the hook returns nonzero,
5739 the insn is not issued on given processors cycle. Instead of that,
5740 the processor cycle is advanced. If the value passed through the last
5741 parameter is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
5742 start as usually. The first parameter passes file for debugging
5743 output. The second one passes the scheduler verbose level of the
5744 debugging output. The forth and the fifth parameter values are
5745 correspondingly processor cycle on which the previous insn has been
5746 issued and the current processor cycle.
5747 @end deftypefn
5748
5749 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_BUBBLES (void)
5750 The @acronym{DFA}-based scheduler could take the insertion of nop
5751 operations for better insn scheduling into account. It can be done
5752 only if the multi-pass insn scheduling works (see hook
5753 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD}).
5754
5755 Let us consider a @acronym{VLIW} processor insn with 3 slots. Each
5756 insn can be placed only in one of the three slots. We have 3 ready
5757 insns @var{A}, @var{B}, and @var{C}. @var{A} and @var{C} can be
5758 placed only in the 1st slot, @var{B} can be placed only in the 3rd
5759 slot. We described the automaton which does not permit empty slot
5760 gaps between insns (usually such description is simpler). Without
5761 this code the scheduler would place each insn in 3 separate
5762 @acronym{VLIW} insns. If the scheduler places a nop insn into the 2nd
5763 slot, it could place the 3 insns into 2 @acronym{VLIW} insns. What is
5764 the nop insn is returned by hook @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_BUBBLE}. Hook
5765 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_BUBBLES} can be used to initialize or
5766 create the nop insns.
5767
5768 You should remember that the scheduler does not insert the nop insns.
5769 It is not wise because of the following optimizations. The scheduler
5770 only considers such possibility to improve the result schedule. The
5771 nop insns should be inserted lately, e.g. on the final phase.
5772 @end deftypefn
5773
5774 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_BUBBLE (int @var{index})
5775 This hook @samp{FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_SCHEDULING} is used to insert
5776 nop operations for better insn scheduling when @acronym{DFA}-based
5777 scheduler makes multipass insn scheduling (see also description of
5778 hook @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_BUBBLES}). This hook
5779 returns a nop insn with given @var{index}. The indexes start with
5780 zero. The hook should return @code{NULL} if there are no more nop
5781 insns with indexes greater than given index.
5782 @end deftypefn
5783
5784 Macros in the following table are generated by the program
5785 @file{genattr} and can be useful for writing the hooks.
5786
5787 @table @code
5788 @findex TRADITIONAL_PIPELINE_INTERFACE
5789 @item TRADITIONAL_PIPELINE_INTERFACE
5790 The macro definition is generated if there is a traditional pipeline
5791 description in @file{.md} file. You should also remember that to
5792 simplify the insn scheduler sources an empty traditional pipeline
5793 description interface is generated even if there is no a traditional
5794 pipeline description in the @file{.md} file. The macro can be used to
5795 distinguish the two types of the traditional interface.
5796
5797 @findex DFA_PIPELINE_INTERFACE
5798 @item DFA_PIPELINE_INTERFACE
5799 The macro definition is generated if there is an automaton pipeline
5800 description in @file{.md} file. You should also remember that to
5801 simplify the insn scheduler sources an empty automaton pipeline
5802 description interface is generated even if there is no an automaton
5803 pipeline description in the @file{.md} file. The macro can be used to
5804 distinguish the two types of the automaton interface.
5805
5806 @findex MAX_DFA_ISSUE_RATE
5807 @item MAX_DFA_ISSUE_RATE
5808 The macro definition is generated in the automaton based pipeline
5809 description interface. Its value is calculated from the automaton
5810 based pipeline description and is equal to maximal number of all insns
5811 described in constructions @samp{define_insn_reservation} which can be
5812 issued on the same processor cycle.
5813
5814 @end table
5815
5816 @node Sections
5817 @section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
5818 @c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
5819 @c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
5820
5821 An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
5822 data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
5823 section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
5824 section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
5825 section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
5826 of sections.
5827
5828 The compiler must tell the assembler when to switch sections. These
5829 macros control what commands to output to tell the assembler this. You
5830 can also define additional sections.
5831
5832 @table @code
5833 @findex TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
5834 @item TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
5835 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
5836 assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
5837 Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
5838
5839 @findex TEXT_SECTION
5840 @item TEXT_SECTION
5841 A C statement that switches to the default section containing instructions.
5842 Normally this is not needed, as simply defining @code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
5843 is enough. The MIPS port uses this to sort all functions after all data
5844 declarations.
5845
5846 @findex HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
5847 @item HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
5848 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
5849 frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
5850 a default definition if the target supports named sections.
5851
5852 @findex UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
5853 @item UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
5854 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
5855 executed functions in the program.
5856
5857 @findex DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
5858 @item DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
5859 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
5860 assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
5861 data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
5862
5863 @findex READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
5864 @item READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
5865 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
5866 assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
5867 data.
5868
5869 @findex READONLY_DATA_SECTION
5870 @item READONLY_DATA_SECTION
5871 A macro naming a function to call to switch to the proper section for
5872 read-only data. The default is to use @code{READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}
5873 if defined, else fall back to @code{text_section}.
5874
5875 The most common definition will be @code{data_section}, if the target
5876 does not have a special read-only data section, and does not put data
5877 in the text section.
5878
5879 @findex SHARED_SECTION_ASM_OP
5880 @item SHARED_SECTION_ASM_OP
5881 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5882 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5883 shared data. If not defined, @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP} will be used.
5884
5885 @findex BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
5886 @item BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
5887 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5888 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5889 uninitialized global data. If not defined, and neither
5890 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} nor @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} are defined,
5891 uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
5892 @option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
5893 used.
5894
5895 @findex SHARED_BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
5896 @item SHARED_BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
5897 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5898 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5899 uninitialized global shared data. If not defined, and
5900 @code{BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP} is, the latter will be used.
5901
5902 @findex INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
5903 @item INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
5904 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5905 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5906 initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
5907 not exist.
5908
5909 @findex FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
5910 @item FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
5911 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
5912 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
5913 finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
5914 not exist.
5915
5916 @findex CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION
5917 @item CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
5918 If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
5919 via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
5920 the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
5921 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
5922 to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
5923 sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
5924 ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
5925 registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
5926 constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
5927
5928 @findex FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
5929 @item FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
5930 If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
5931 arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
5932 @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
5933 and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
5934
5935 @findex EXTRA_SECTIONS
5936 @findex in_text
5937 @findex in_data
5938 @item EXTRA_SECTIONS
5939 A list of names for sections other than the standard two, which are
5940 @code{in_text} and @code{in_data}. You need not define this macro
5941 on a system with no other sections (that GCC needs to use).
5942
5943 @findex EXTRA_SECTION_FUNCTIONS
5944 @findex text_section
5945 @findex data_section
5946 @item EXTRA_SECTION_FUNCTIONS
5947 One or more functions to be defined in @file{varasm.c}. These
5948 functions should do jobs analogous to those of @code{text_section} and
5949 @code{data_section}, for your additional sections. Do not define this
5950 macro if you do not define @code{EXTRA_SECTIONS}.
5951
5952 @findex JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
5953 @item JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
5954 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
5955 tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
5956 section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
5957 readonly data section is used.
5958
5959 This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
5960 @end table
5961
5962 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION (tree @var{exp}, int @var{reloc}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
5963 Switches to the appropriate section for output of @var{exp}. You can
5964 assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
5965 some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
5966 requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
5967 local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
5968 Select the section by calling @code{data_section} or one of the
5969 alternatives for other sections. @var{align} is the constant alignment
5970 in bits.
5971
5972 The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
5973 variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
5974 @end deftypefn
5975
5976 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, int @var{reloc})
5977 Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
5978 and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
5979 As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
5980 the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
5981
5982 The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
5983 ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
5984 example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
5985 Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
5986 @end deftypefn
5987
5988 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION (enum machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
5989 Switches to the appropriate section for output of constant pool entry
5990 @var{x} in @var{mode}. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
5991 constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
5992 case of a @code{const_int} rtx. Select the section by calling
5993 @code{readonly_data_section} or one of the alternatives for other
5994 sections. @var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
5995
5996 The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
5997 constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
5998 else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
5999 @end deftypefn
6000
6001 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO (tree @var{decl}, int @var{new_decl_p})
6002 Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
6003 treated differently depending on something about the variable or
6004 function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
6005
6006 The hook is executed under two circumstances. One is immediately after
6007 the rtl for @var{decl} that represents a variable or a function has been
6008 created and stored in @code{DECL_RTL(@var{decl})}. The value of the rtl
6009 will be a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. The other is
6010 immediately after the rtl for @var{decl} that represents a constant has
6011 been created and stored in @code{TREE_CST_RTL (@var{decl})}. The macro
6012 is called once for each distinct constant in a source file.
6013
6014 The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
6015 that @code{ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
6016 be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
6017 declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
6018 declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
6019
6020 @cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
6021 The usual thing for this hook to do is to record a flag in the
6022 @code{symbol_ref} (such as @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}) or to store a
6023 modified name string in the @code{symbol_ref} (if one bit is not
6024 enough information).
6025 @end deftypefn
6026
6027 @deftypefn {Target Hook} const char *TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING (const char *name)
6028 Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
6029 the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
6030 may have added.
6031 @end deftypefn
6032
6033 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P (tree @var{exp})
6034 Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
6035 The default version of this hook always returns false.
6036 @end deftypefn
6037
6038 @deftypevar {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
6039 Contains the value true if the target places read-only
6040 ``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
6041 @end deftypevar
6042
6043 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P (tree @var{exp})
6044 Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
6045 rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
6046 or executable image).
6047
6048 The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
6049 for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
6050 currently supported object file formats.
6051 @end deftypefn
6052
6053 @deftypevar {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_TLS
6054 Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
6055 The default value is false.
6056 @end deftypevar
6057
6058
6059 @node PIC
6060 @section Position Independent Code
6061 @cindex position independent code
6062 @cindex PIC
6063
6064 This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
6065 independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
6066 generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the macros
6067 @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} and @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as
6068 well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You must modify the definition of
6069 @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate when the source operand
6070 contains a symbolic address. You may also need to alter the handling of
6071 switch statements so that they use relative addresses.
6072 @c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
6073 @c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
6074
6075 @table @code
6076 @findex PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
6077 @item PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
6078 The register number of the register used to address a table of static
6079 data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
6080 processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
6081 is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
6082 pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
6083 is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
6084 necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
6085 when @code{flag_pic} is true).
6086
6087 @findex PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
6088 @item PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
6089 Define this macro if the register defined by
6090 @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. Do not define
6091 this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
6092
6093 @findex FINALIZE_PIC
6094 @item FINALIZE_PIC
6095 By generating position-independent code, when two different programs (A
6096 and B) share a common library (libC.a), the text of the library can be
6097 shared whether or not the library is linked at the same address for both
6098 programs. In some of these environments, position-independent code
6099 requires not only the use of different addressing modes, but also
6100 special code to enable the use of these addressing modes.
6101
6102 The @code{FINALIZE_PIC} macro serves as a hook to emit these special
6103 codes once the function is being compiled into assembly code, but not
6104 before. (It is not done before, because in the case of compiling an
6105 inline function, it would lead to multiple PIC prologues being
6106 included in functions which used inline functions and were compiled to
6107 assembly language.)
6108
6109 @findex LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P
6110 @item LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
6111 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
6112 operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
6113 You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
6114 check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
6115 check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
6116 (including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
6117 position independent code.
6118 @end table
6119
6120 @node Assembler Format
6121 @section Defining the Output Assembler Language
6122
6123 This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
6124 to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
6125 instructions do.
6126
6127 @menu
6128 * File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
6129 * Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
6130 * Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
6131 * Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
6132 * Initialization:: General principles of initialization
6133 and termination routines.
6134 * Macros for Initialization::
6135 Specific macros that control the handling of
6136 initialization and termination routines.
6137 * Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
6138 * Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
6139 * Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
6140 * Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
6141 @end menu
6142
6143 @node File Framework
6144 @subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
6145 @cindex assembler format
6146 @cindex output of assembler code
6147
6148 @c prevent bad page break with this line
6149 This describes the overall framework of an assembler file.
6150
6151 @table @code
6152 @findex ASM_FILE_START
6153 @item ASM_FILE_START (@var{stream})
6154 A C expression which outputs to the stdio stream @var{stream}
6155 some appropriate text to go at the start of an assembler file.
6156
6157 Normally this macro is defined to output a line containing
6158 @samp{#NO_APP}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
6159 assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it can save time by not
6160 checking for certain assembler constructs.
6161
6162 On systems that use SDB, it is necessary to output certain commands;
6163 see @file{attasm.h}.
6164
6165 @findex ASM_FILE_END
6166 @item ASM_FILE_END (@var{stream})
6167 A C expression which outputs to the stdio stream @var{stream}
6168 some appropriate text to go at the end of an assembler file.
6169
6170 If this macro is not defined, the default is to output nothing
6171 special at the end of the file. Most systems don't require any
6172 definition.
6173
6174 On systems that use SDB, it is necessary to output certain commands;
6175 see @file{attasm.h}.
6176
6177 @findex ASM_COMMENT_START
6178 @item ASM_COMMENT_START
6179 A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
6180 assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
6181 the end of the line.
6182
6183 @findex ASM_APP_ON
6184 @item ASM_APP_ON
6185 A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
6186 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
6187 @code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
6188 assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
6189 that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
6190
6191 @findex ASM_APP_OFF
6192 @item ASM_APP_OFF
6193 A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
6194 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
6195 @code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
6196 time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
6197
6198 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME
6199 @item ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6200 A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
6201 which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
6202 the stdio stream @var{stream}.
6203
6204 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
6205 for the file format in use is appropriate.
6206
6207 @findex OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING
6208 @item OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
6209 A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
6210 @var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
6211 in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
6212 the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
6213 of the filename using this macro.
6214
6215 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE
6216 @item ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
6217 A C statement to output DBX or SDB debugging information before code
6218 for line number @var{line} of the current source file to the
6219 stdio stream @var{stream}.
6220
6221 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of debugging
6222 information for the debugger in use is appropriate.
6223
6224 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT
6225 @item ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (@var{stream}, @var{string})
6226 A C statement to output something to the assembler file to handle a
6227 @samp{#ident} directive containing the text @var{string}. If this
6228 macro is not defined, nothing is output for a @samp{#ident} directive.
6229
6230 @findex OBJC_PROLOGUE
6231 @item OBJC_PROLOGUE
6232 A C statement to output any assembler statements which are required to
6233 precede any Objective-C object definitions or message sending. The
6234 statement is executed only when compiling an Objective-C program.
6235 @end table
6236
6237 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION (const char *@var{name}, unsigned int @var{flags}, unsigned int @var{align})
6238 Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
6239 should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
6240 of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{align}
6241 is nonzero, it contains an alignment in bytes to be used for the section,
6242 otherwise some target default should be used. Only targets that must
6243 specify an alignment within the section directive need pay attention to
6244 @var{align} -- we will still use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}.
6245 @end deftypefn
6246
6247 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
6248 This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
6249 @end deftypefn
6250
6251 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{name}, int @var{reloc})
6252 Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
6253 based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
6254 declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
6255 null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
6256
6257 The default version if this function handles choosing code vs data,
6258 read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
6259 need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
6260 set via @code{__attribute__}.
6261 @end deftypefn
6262
6263 @need 2000
6264 @node Data Output
6265 @subsection Output of Data
6266
6267
6268 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
6269 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
6270 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
6271 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
6272 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
6273 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
6274 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
6275 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
6276 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
6277 These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
6278 of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
6279 byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
6280 aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
6281 @code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
6282
6283 The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
6284 followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
6285 the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
6286 @end deftypevr
6287
6288 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_INTEGER (rtx @var{x}, unsigned int @var{size}, int @var{aligned_p})
6289 The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
6290 integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
6291 in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
6292 function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
6293 object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
6294 split the object into smaller parts.
6295
6296 The default implementation of this hook will use the
6297 @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
6298 when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
6299 @end deftypefn
6300
6301 @table @code
6302 @findex OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA
6303 @item OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{fail})
6304 A C statement to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that
6305 @code{output_addr_const} can't deal with, and output assembly code to
6306 @var{stream} corresponding to the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to
6307 allow machine-dependent @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
6308
6309 If @code{OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA} fails to recognize a pattern, it must
6310 @code{goto fail}, so that a standard error message is printed. If it
6311 prints an error message itself, by calling, for example,
6312 @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just complete normally.
6313
6314 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII
6315 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
6316 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
6317 instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
6318 bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
6319 @code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
6320
6321 If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
6322 Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
6323 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
6324
6325 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC
6326 @item ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
6327 A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
6328 @var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
6329 is defined, and is otherwise unused.
6330
6331 @findex CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
6332 @item CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
6333 You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
6334 expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
6335 pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
6336 GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
6337 not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
6338 pool before the function.
6339
6340 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE
6341 @item ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
6342 A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
6343 constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
6344 the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
6345 be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
6346 is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
6347 immediately after this call.
6348
6349 If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
6350 not be defined.
6351
6352 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY
6353 @item ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
6354 A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
6355 constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
6356 anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
6357
6358 The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
6359 assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
6360 output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
6361 @samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
6362 @var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
6363 alignment.
6364
6365 The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
6366 the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
6367 responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
6368 Here is how to do this:
6369
6370 @example
6371 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
6372 @end example
6373
6374 When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
6375 @code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
6376 entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
6377
6378 You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
6379
6380 @findex CONSTANT_AFTER_FUNCTION_P
6381 @item CONSTANT_AFTER_FUNCTION_P (@var{exp})
6382 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if the constant
6383 @var{exp}, of type @code{tree}, should be output after the code for a
6384 function. The compiler will normally output all constants before the
6385 function; you need not define this macro if this is OK@.
6386
6387 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE
6388 @item ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
6389 A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
6390 pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
6391 function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
6392 obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
6393 constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
6394
6395 If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
6396 define this macro.
6397
6398 @findex IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR
6399 @item IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C})
6400 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
6401 used as a logical line separator by the assembler.
6402
6403 If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
6404 the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
6405 @end table
6406
6407 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
6408 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_CLOSE_PAREN
6409 These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
6410 assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
6411 default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
6412 @end deftypevr
6413
6414 These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
6415 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
6416
6417 @table @code
6418 @item REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
6419 @itemx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
6420 @itemx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
6421 @findex REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE
6422 @findex REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE
6423 @findex REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE
6424 These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the target's
6425 floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in the variable
6426 @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE}, this variable should
6427 be a simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
6428 @code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined by
6429 the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of it
6430 go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds 32
6431 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits on the
6432 host machine.
6433
6434 The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
6435 using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
6436 machine's memory.
6437 @end table
6438
6439 @node Uninitialized Data
6440 @subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
6441
6442 Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
6443 outputting a single uninitialized variable.
6444
6445 @table @code
6446 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON
6447 @item ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6448 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6449 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
6450 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
6451 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
6452
6453 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
6454 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
6455 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
6456
6457 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
6458 common global variables are output.
6459
6460 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON
6461 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6462 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
6463 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
6464 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
6465 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
6466 as the number of bits.
6467
6468 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON
6469 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6470 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
6471 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
6472 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
6473 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
6474 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
6475 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
6476
6477 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_COMMON
6478 @item ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6479 If defined, it is similar to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, except that it
6480 is used when @var{name} is shared. If not defined, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}
6481 will be used.
6482
6483 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_BSS
6484 @item ASM_OUTPUT_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6485 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6486 @var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
6487 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
6488 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
6489
6490 Try to use function @code{asm_output_bss} defined in @file{varasm.c} when
6491 defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
6492 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
6493 before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
6494 the name, and a newline.
6495
6496 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized global
6497 variables are output. This macro exists to properly support languages like
6498 C++ which do not have @code{common} data. However, this macro currently
6499 is not defined for all targets. If this macro and
6500 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} are not defined then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}
6501 or @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} or
6502 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON} is used.
6503
6504 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS
6505 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6506 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} except takes the required alignment as a
6507 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
6508 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS}, and gives you more flexibility in
6509 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
6510 as the number of bits.
6511
6512 Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
6513 @file{varasm.c} when defining this macro.
6514
6515 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_BSS
6516 @item ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6517 If defined, it is similar to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS}, except that it
6518 is used when @var{name} is shared. If not defined, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS}
6519 will be used.
6520
6521 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL
6522 @item ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6523 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6524 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
6525 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
6526 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
6527
6528 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
6529 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
6530 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
6531
6532 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
6533 static variables are output.
6534
6535 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL
6536 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6537 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
6538 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
6539 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
6540 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
6541 as the number of bits.
6542
6543 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL
6544 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
6545 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
6546 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
6547 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
6548 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
6549 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
6550 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
6551
6552 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_LOCAL
6553 @item ASM_OUTPUT_SHARED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
6554 If defined, it is similar to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, except that it
6555 is used when @var{name} is shared. If not defined, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}
6556 will be used.
6557 @end table
6558
6559 @node Label Output
6560 @subsection Output and Generation of Labels
6561
6562 @c prevent bad page break with this line
6563 This is about outputting labels.
6564
6565 @table @code
6566 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL
6567 @findex assemble_name
6568 @item ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6569 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6570 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
6571 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
6572 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
6573 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
6574 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
6575
6576 @findex SIZE_ASM_OP
6577 @item SIZE_ASM_OP
6578 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
6579 size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
6580 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
6581 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
6582
6583 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
6584 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
6585 for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
6586 macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
6587 define this macro.
6588
6589 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE
6590 @item ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
6591 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6592 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
6593 symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
6594 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
6595 provided.
6596
6597 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE
6598 @item ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6599 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6600 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
6601 the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
6602 address.
6603
6604 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
6605 provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
6606 @samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
6607 the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
6608 not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
6609 to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
6610
6611 @findex TYPE_ASM_OP
6612 @item TYPE_ASM_OP
6613 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
6614 type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
6615 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
6616 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
6617
6618 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
6619 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
6620 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
6621 types at all, do not define this macro.
6622
6623 @findex TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
6624 @item TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
6625 A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
6626 the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
6627 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
6628 the default is not to define this macro.
6629
6630 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
6631 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
6632 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
6633 types at all, do not define this macro.
6634
6635 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE
6636 @item ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
6637 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6638 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
6639 symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
6640 that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
6641 you should not count on this.
6642
6643 If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
6644 definition of this macro is provided.
6645
6646 @findex ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME
6647 @item ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
6648 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6649 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
6650 function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
6651 outputting the label definition (perhaps using
6652 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
6653 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
6654
6655 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
6656 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
6657
6658 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
6659 of this macro.
6660
6661 @findex ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE
6662 @item ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
6663 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6664 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
6665 which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
6666 function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
6667 representing the function.
6668
6669 If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
6670
6671 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
6672 of this macro.
6673
6674 @findex ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME
6675 @item ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
6676 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6677 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
6678 initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
6679 label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
6680 @var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
6681
6682 If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
6683 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
6684
6685 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
6686 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
6687
6688 @findex ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL
6689 @item ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
6690 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6691 @var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
6692 for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
6693
6694 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
6695 nothing.
6696
6697 @findex ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT
6698 @item ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
6699 A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
6700 once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
6701 chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
6702 initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
6703 something about the size of the object.
6704
6705 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
6706 nothing.
6707
6708 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
6709 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
6710 @end table
6711
6712 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name})
6713 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
6714 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
6715 that is, available for reference from other files.
6716
6717 The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
6718 @code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
6719 @end deftypefn
6720
6721 @table @code
6722 @findex ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL
6723 @item ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6724 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6725 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
6726 that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
6727 no other definition is available. Use the expression
6728 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
6729 itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
6730 for making that name weak, and a newline.
6731
6732 If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
6733 support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
6734 macro.
6735
6736 @findex ASM_WEAKEN_DECL
6737 @item ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
6738 Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
6739 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
6740 or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
6741 should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
6742 defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
6743 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
6744 to make @var{name} weak.
6745
6746 @findex SUPPORTS_WEAK
6747 @item SUPPORTS_WEAK
6748 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
6749
6750 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
6751 definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
6752 is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is
6753 @samp{0}. Define this macro if you want to control weak symbol support
6754 with a compiler flag such as @option{-melf}.
6755
6756 @findex MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
6757 @item MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY
6758 A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
6759 public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
6760 be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
6761 format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
6762 section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
6763 requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
6764
6765 @findex SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
6766 @item SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
6767 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
6768 semantics.
6769
6770 If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
6771 definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
6772 definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
6773 you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
6774 setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
6775 be emitted as one-only.
6776
6777 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{visibility})
6778 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
6779 commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
6780 hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
6781 @end deftypefn
6782
6783 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL
6784 @item ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
6785 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6786 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
6787 symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
6788 not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
6789 declaration.
6790
6791 This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
6792 The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
6793
6794 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL
6795 @item ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL (@var{stream}, @var{symref})
6796 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output on @var{stream} an assembler
6797 pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
6798 library function is given by @var{symref}, which has type @code{rtx} and
6799 is a @code{symbol_ref}.
6800
6801 This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
6802 The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
6803
6804 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF
6805 @item ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6806 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6807 @var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
6808 @var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
6809 is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
6810 systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
6811
6812 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF
6813 @item ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
6814 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
6815 @code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
6816 will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
6817 to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
6818 encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
6819
6820 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF
6821 @item ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
6822 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
6823 result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
6824 @code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
6825 This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
6826 specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
6827 when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
6828 being taken.
6829 @end table
6830
6831 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{prefix}, unsigned long @var{labelno})
6832 A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
6833 name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
6834
6835 It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
6836 used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
6837 will have name conflicts with internal labels.
6838
6839 It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
6840 object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
6841 should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
6842 beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
6843 convention your system uses, and follow it.
6844
6845 The default version of this function utilizes ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL.
6846
6847 @end deftypefn
6848
6849 @table @code
6850 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL
6851 @item ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
6852 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
6853 label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
6854 @var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
6855 may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
6856 systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
6857 bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
6858 bundles.
6859
6860 If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
6861 used.
6862
6863 @findex ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL
6864 @item ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
6865 A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
6866 is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
6867
6868 This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
6869 produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
6870 with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
6871
6872 If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
6873 output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
6874 @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
6875 string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
6876 to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
6877 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
6878 you should know what it does on your machine.)
6879
6880 @findex ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME
6881 @item ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
6882 A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
6883 @code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
6884 @var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
6885 added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
6886
6887 The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
6888 produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
6889 @var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
6890 assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
6891 macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
6892 internal static variables in different scopes.
6893
6894 Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
6895 conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
6896 or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
6897 between the name and the number will suffice.
6898
6899 If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
6900 which is correct for most systems.
6901
6902 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_DEF
6903 @item ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
6904 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
6905 which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
6906
6907 @findex SET_ASM_OP
6908 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
6909 correct for most systems.
6910
6911 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS
6912 @item ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
6913 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
6914 which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
6915 to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
6916 be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
6917 the tree nodes are available.
6918
6919 @findex SET_ASM_OP
6920 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
6921 correct for most systems.
6922
6923 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS
6924 @item ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
6925 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
6926 which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
6927 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
6928 an undefined weak symbol.
6929
6930 Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
6931 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
6932
6933 @findex OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL
6934 @item OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
6935 Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
6936 Objective-C methods.
6937
6938 The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
6939 class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
6940 the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
6941 @samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
6942
6943 These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
6944 the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
6945 systems define other ways of computing names.
6946
6947 @var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
6948 buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
6949 @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
6950 50 characters extra.
6951
6952 The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
6953 method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
6954 @var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
6955 in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
6956
6957 On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
6958 macro to provide more human-readable names.
6959
6960 @findex ASM_DECLARE_CLASS_REFERENCE
6961 @item ASM_DECLARE_CLASS_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6962 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6963 @var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
6964 Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets whose
6965 linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
6966
6967 @findex ASM_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_REFERENCE
6968 @item ASM_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
6969 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
6970 @var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
6971 unresolved Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets
6972 whose linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
6973 @end table
6974
6975 @node Initialization
6976 @subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
6977 @cindex initialization routines
6978 @cindex termination routines
6979 @cindex constructors, output of
6980 @cindex destructors, output of
6981
6982 The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
6983 (also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
6984 data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
6985 to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
6986 @code{main} is called.
6987
6988 Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
6989 @dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
6990 terminates.
6991
6992 To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
6993 must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
6994 be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
6995 system, you need to specify how to do this.
6996
6997 There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
6998 initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
6999 Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
7000
7001 @findex __CTOR_LIST__
7002 @findex __DTOR_LIST__
7003 The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
7004 initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
7005 termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
7006
7007 Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
7008 0, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
7009 the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
7010 pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
7011 pointer containing zero.
7012
7013 Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
7014 @file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
7015 time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
7016 list; destructors in forward order.
7017
7018 The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
7019 formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
7020 aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
7021 Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
7022 object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
7023 the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
7024 accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
7025 Termination functions are handled similarly.
7026
7027 This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
7028 @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
7029 support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
7030 constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
7031 and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
7032
7033 When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
7034 upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
7035 support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
7036 parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
7037 program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
7038
7039 @example
7040 ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
7041 @end example
7042
7043 The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
7044 section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
7045 for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
7046 files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
7047 are provided by GCC for a few targets.
7048
7049 The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
7050 compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
7051 fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
7052 to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
7053 of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
7054 that invokes the routines we need at startup.
7055
7056 To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
7057 macro properly.
7058
7059 If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
7060 @code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
7061 entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
7062 it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
7063 after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
7064 in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
7065
7066 In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
7067 two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
7068 and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
7069 @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
7070 entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
7071 and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
7072 code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
7073 the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
7074 placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
7075 a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
7076 @code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
7077 section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
7078 the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
7079 the initialization process.
7080
7081 The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
7082 This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
7083 file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
7084 this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
7085 termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
7086 an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
7087 pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
7088 the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
7089 initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
7090 via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
7091 @code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
7092
7093 @ifinfo
7094 The following section describes the specific macros that control and
7095 customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
7096 @end ifinfo
7097
7098 @node Macros for Initialization
7099 @subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
7100
7101 Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
7102 and termination functions:
7103
7104 @table @code
7105 @findex INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
7106 @item INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
7107 If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
7108 operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
7109 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
7110 using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
7111 macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
7112 run the initialization functions.
7113
7114 @item HAS_INIT_SECTION
7115 @findex HAS_INIT_SECTION
7116 If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
7117 This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
7118 on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
7119 be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
7120
7121 @item LD_INIT_SWITCH
7122 @findex LD_INIT_SWITCH
7123 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
7124 the following symbol is an initialization routine.
7125
7126 @item LD_FINI_SWITCH
7127 @findex LD_FINI_SWITCH
7128 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
7129 the following symbol is a finalization routine.
7130
7131 @item COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
7132 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
7133 automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
7134 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
7135 the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
7136 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
7137
7138 This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
7139 shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
7140 exception tables embedded in the code.
7141
7142 @item COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
7143 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
7144 automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
7145 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
7146 the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
7147 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
7148
7149 @item INVOKE__main
7150 @findex INVOKE__main
7151 If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
7152 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
7153 where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
7154 useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
7155
7156 @item SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
7157 @findex SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
7158 If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
7159 compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
7160 of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
7161 encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
7162 @end table
7163
7164 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
7165 This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
7166 collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
7167 It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
7168 @end deftypefn
7169
7170 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
7171 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
7172 the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
7173
7174 Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
7175 no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
7176 priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
7177 otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
7178
7179 If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
7180 be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
7181 target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
7182 is not defined.
7183 @end deftypefn
7184
7185 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
7186 This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
7187 functions rather than initialization functions.
7188 @end deftypefn
7189
7190 If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
7191 generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
7192
7193 If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
7194 constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
7195 an object file for constructor functions to be called.
7196
7197 On certain kinds of systems, you can define these macros to make
7198 @command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
7199
7200 @table @code
7201 @findex OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
7202 @item OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
7203 Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
7204 object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
7205 object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
7206
7207 @findex OBJECT_FORMAT_ROSE
7208 @item OBJECT_FORMAT_ROSE
7209 Define this macro if the system uses ROSE format object files, so that
7210 @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan object files directly
7211 for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
7212
7213 These macros are effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
7214 part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
7215
7216 @findex REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
7217 @item REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
7218 Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
7219 to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
7220 @command{nm}.
7221
7222 If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
7223 dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
7224 these macros to enable support for running initialization and
7225 termination functions in shared libraries:
7226
7227 @findex LDD_SUFFIX
7228 @item LDD_SUFFIX
7229 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
7230 which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{"ldd"} under SunOS 4.
7231
7232 @findex PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT
7233 @item PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
7234 Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
7235 of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
7236 of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
7237 from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
7238 code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
7239 line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
7240 @end table
7241
7242 @node Instruction Output
7243 @subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
7244
7245 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7246 This describes assembler instruction output.
7247
7248 @table @code
7249 @findex REGISTER_NAMES
7250 @item REGISTER_NAMES
7251 A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
7252 registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
7253 register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
7254
7255 @findex ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
7256 @item ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
7257 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
7258 and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
7259 registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
7260 to registers using alternate names.
7261
7262 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE
7263 @item ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
7264 Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
7265 requires different names for the machine instructions.
7266
7267 The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
7268 assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
7269 macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
7270 points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
7271 written in the machine description. The definition should output the
7272 opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
7273 increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
7274 so that it will not be output twice.
7275
7276 In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
7277 name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
7278 that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
7279 care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
7280 @var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
7281
7282 @findex recog_data.operand
7283 If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
7284 elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
7285
7286 If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
7287 in the usual way.
7288
7289 @findex FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN
7290 @item FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
7291 If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
7292 assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
7293 they will be output differently.
7294
7295 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
7296 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
7297 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
7298 The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
7299 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
7300 by changing the contents of the vector.
7301
7302 This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
7303 file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
7304 can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
7305 as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
7306 syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
7307 writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
7308
7309 If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
7310
7311 @findex FINAL_PRESCAN_LABEL
7312 @item FINAL_PRESCAN_LABEL
7313 If defined, @code{FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN} will be called on each
7314 @code{CODE_LABEL}. In that case, @var{opvec} will be a null pointer and
7315 @var{noperands} will be zero.
7316
7317 @findex PRINT_OPERAND
7318 @item PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
7319 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
7320 assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
7321 RTL expression.
7322
7323 @var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
7324 of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
7325 printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
7326 the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
7327 operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
7328 @var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
7329 @var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
7330
7331 @findex reg_names
7332 If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
7333 The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
7334 @code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
7335 @code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
7336
7337 When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
7338 (a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
7339 with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
7340 @var{code}.
7341
7342 @findex PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P
7343 @item PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
7344 A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
7345 punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
7346 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
7347 punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
7348 in this way.
7349
7350 @findex PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS
7351 @item PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
7352 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
7353 assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
7354 whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
7355
7356 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
7357 On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
7358 section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
7359 @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
7360 @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler Format}.
7361
7362 @findex DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND
7363 @findex dbr_sequence_length
7364 @item DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND(@var{file})
7365 A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
7366 been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
7367 determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
7368 currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
7369 or whatever.
7370
7371 Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
7372 reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
7373 explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
7374
7375 @findex final_sequence
7376 Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
7377 prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
7378 (i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
7379 found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
7380 processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
7381 being output.
7382
7383 @findex REGISTER_PREFIX
7384 @findex LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
7385 @findex USER_LABEL_PREFIX
7386 @findex IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
7387 @findex asm_fprintf
7388 @item REGISTER_PREFIX
7389 @itemx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
7390 @itemx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
7391 @itemx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
7392 If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
7393 @samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
7394 @file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
7395 support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
7396 files can define these macros differently.
7397
7398 @item ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS(@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
7399 @findex ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS
7400 If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
7401 statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
7402 the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
7403 printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
7404 statements. Note that upper case letters are reserved for future
7405 generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
7406 specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
7407 The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
7408 string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
7409 upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
7410
7411 @findex ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
7412 @item ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
7413 If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
7414 different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
7415 numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
7416 first variant.
7417
7418 If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
7419 @smallexample
7420 @samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
7421 @end smallexample
7422 @noindent
7423 in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
7424 first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
7425 @samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
7426 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
7427 within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
7428 alternatives within the braces than the value of
7429 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing.
7430
7431 If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
7432 @samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
7433 operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
7434
7435 Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
7436 @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
7437 the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
7438 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
7439 if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
7440 opcodes or operand order.
7441
7442 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH
7443 @item ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
7444 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
7445 which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
7446 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
7447 profiling.
7448
7449 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP
7450 @item ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
7451 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
7452 which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
7453 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
7454 profiling.
7455 @end table
7456
7457 @node Dispatch Tables
7458 @subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
7459
7460 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7461 This concerns dispatch tables.
7462
7463 @table @code
7464 @cindex dispatch table
7465 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT
7466 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
7467 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7468 pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
7469 @var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
7470 definitions of these labels are output using
7471 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
7472 way here. For example,
7473
7474 @example
7475 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
7476 @var{value}, @var{rel})
7477 @end example
7478
7479 You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
7480 dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
7481 will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
7482 @var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
7483 mode and flags can be read.
7484
7485 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT
7486 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
7487 This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
7488 in a dispatch table are absolute.
7489
7490 The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
7491 @var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
7492 a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
7493 definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
7494 For example,
7495
7496 @example
7497 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
7498 @end example
7499
7500 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL
7501 @item ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
7502 Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
7503 specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
7504 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
7505 jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
7506 @code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
7507
7508 This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
7509 for the table.
7510
7511 If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
7512 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
7513
7514 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END
7515 @item ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
7516 Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
7517 jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
7518 after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
7519 the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
7520 @var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
7521 of the preceding label.
7522
7523 If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
7524 the jump-table.
7525 @end table
7526
7527 @node Exception Region Output
7528 @subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
7529
7530 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7531
7532 This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
7533 region.
7534
7535 @table @code
7536 @findex EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
7537 @item EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
7538 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
7539 exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
7540 provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
7541 @file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
7542
7543 You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
7544 unwind information and the default definition does not work.
7545
7546 @findex EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
7547 @item EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
7548 If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
7549 data section even though the target supports named sections. This
7550 might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
7551 collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
7552
7553 Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
7554 also defined.
7555
7556 @findex MASK_RETURN_ADDR
7557 @item MASK_RETURN_ADDR
7558 An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
7559 that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
7560
7561 @findex DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
7562 @item DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
7563 Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
7564 information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
7565 Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
7566 @samp{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either @samp{UNALIGNED_INT_ASM_OP}
7567 or @samp{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}), GCC will provide a default definition of
7568 1.
7569
7570 If this macro is defined to 1, the DWARF 2 unwinder will be the default
7571 exception handling mechanism; otherwise, @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} will be used by
7572 default.
7573
7574 If this macro is defined to anything, the DWARF 2 unwinder will be used
7575 instead of inline unwinders and @code{__unwind_function} in the non-@code{setjmp} case.
7576
7577 @findex DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
7578 @item DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
7579 This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
7580 function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
7581 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
7582 alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
7583 minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
7584 the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
7585
7586 @end table
7587
7588 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EXCEPTION_SECTION ()
7589 If defined, a function that switches to the section in which the main
7590 exception table is to be placed (@pxref{Sections}). The default is a
7591 function that switches to a section named @code{.gcc_except_table} on
7592 machines that support named sections via
7593 @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}, otherwise if @option{-fpic} or
7594 @option{-fPIC} is in effect, the @code{data_section}, otherwise the
7595 @code{readonly_data_section}.
7596 @end deftypefn
7597
7598 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EH_FRAME_SECTION ()
7599 If defined, a function that switches to the section in which the DWARF 2
7600 frame unwind information to be placed (@pxref{Sections}). The default
7601 is a function that outputs a standard GAS section directive, if
7602 @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, or else a data section
7603 directive followed by a synthetic label.
7604 @end deftypefn
7605
7606 @deftypevar {Target Hook} bool TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
7607 Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
7608 end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
7609 Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
7610 true otherwise.
7611 @end deftypevar
7612
7613 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN (rtx @var{reg})
7614 Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
7615 represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
7616 register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
7617 locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
7618 register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
7619 If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
7620 @end deftypefn
7621
7622 @node Alignment Output
7623 @subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
7624
7625 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7626 This describes commands for alignment.
7627
7628 @table @code
7629 @findex JUMP_ALIGN
7630 @item JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
7631 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
7632 a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
7633
7634 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
7635 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
7636 define the macro.
7637
7638 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
7639 to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
7640 @code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
7641 selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
7642
7643 @findex LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER
7644 @item LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
7645 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
7646 a @code{BARRIER}.
7647
7648 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
7649 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
7650 define the macro.
7651
7652 @findex LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP
7653 @item LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP
7654 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying
7655 @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
7656 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
7657
7658 @findex LOOP_ALIGN
7659 @item LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
7660 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
7661 a @code{NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG} note.
7662
7663 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
7664 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
7665 define the macro.
7666
7667 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
7668 to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
7669 @code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
7670 selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
7671
7672 @findex LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
7673 @item LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
7674 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN}.
7675 This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
7676
7677 @findex LABEL_ALIGN
7678 @item LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
7679 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
7680 If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
7681 the maximum of the specified values is used.
7682
7683 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
7684 to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
7685 @code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
7686 selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
7687
7688 @findex LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
7689 @item LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
7690 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}.
7691 This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
7692
7693 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP
7694 @item ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
7695 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7696 instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
7697 Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
7698 expression of type @code{int}.
7699
7700 @findex ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
7701 @item ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
7702 Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
7703 text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
7704 This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
7705 produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
7706 section.
7707
7708 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN
7709 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
7710 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7711 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
7712 @var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
7713
7714 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP
7715 @item ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
7716 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
7717 for padding, if necessary.
7718
7719 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN
7720 @item ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
7721 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7722 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
7723 @var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
7724 satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
7725 a C expression of type @code{int}.
7726 @end table
7727
7728 @need 3000
7729 @node Debugging Info
7730 @section Controlling Debugging Information Format
7731
7732 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7733 This describes how to specify debugging information.
7734
7735 @menu
7736 * All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
7737 * DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
7738 * DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
7739 * File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
7740 * SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
7741 * VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
7742 @end menu
7743
7744 @node All Debuggers
7745 @subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
7746
7747 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7748 These macros affect all debugging formats.
7749
7750 @table @code
7751 @findex DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER
7752 @item DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
7753 A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
7754 register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
7755 of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
7756 some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
7757 versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
7758 compiler and another for DBX@.
7759
7760 If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
7761 used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
7762 consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
7763 Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
7764 expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
7765
7766 If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
7767 does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
7768 redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
7769
7770 @findex DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET
7771 @item DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
7772 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
7773 variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
7774 computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
7775 gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
7776 that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
7777 for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
7778 @option{-g} options is used.
7779
7780 @findex DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET
7781 @item DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
7782 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
7783 having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
7784 @var{offset}.
7785
7786 @findex PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
7787 @item PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
7788 A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
7789 produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
7790 this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
7791 debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
7792 @code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
7793 @code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
7794
7795 When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
7796 value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
7797 exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined and
7798 @code{LINKER_DOES_NOT_WORK_WITH_DWARF2} is not defined, GCC uses the
7799 value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
7800 defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
7801
7802 The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
7803 user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
7804 @option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-1}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff},
7805 or @option{-gvms}.
7806 @end table
7807
7808 @node DBX Options
7809 @subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
7810
7811 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7812 These are specific options for DBX output.
7813
7814 @table @code
7815 @findex DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
7816 @item DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
7817 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
7818 in response to the @option{-g} option.
7819
7820 @findex XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
7821 @item XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
7822 Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
7823 in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
7824
7825 @findex DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
7826 @item DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
7827 Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
7828 GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
7829 debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
7830 macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
7831 if there is any occasion to.
7832
7833 @findex DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
7834 @item DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
7835 Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
7836 in the text section.
7837
7838 @findex ASM_STABS_OP
7839 @item ASM_STABS_OP
7840 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
7841 use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
7842 If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
7843 applies only to DBX debugging information format.
7844
7845 @findex ASM_STABD_OP
7846 @item ASM_STABD_OP
7847 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
7848 use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
7849 value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
7850 @code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
7851 information format.
7852
7853 @findex ASM_STABN_OP
7854 @item ASM_STABN_OP
7855 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
7856 use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
7857 name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
7858 macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
7859
7860 @findex DBX_NO_XREFS
7861 @item DBX_NO_XREFS
7862 Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
7863 @samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
7864 describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
7865 On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
7866
7867 @findex DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
7868 @item DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
7869 A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
7870 continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
7871 exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
7872 operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
7873 must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
7874 with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
7875 defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
7876
7877 @findex DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
7878 @item DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
7879 Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
7880 the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
7881 a different character instead, define this macro as a character
7882 constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
7883 if backslash is correct for your system.
7884
7885 @findex DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
7886 @item DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
7887 Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
7888 outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
7889 variable.
7890
7891 @findex DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
7892 @item DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
7893 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
7894 for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
7895
7896 @findex DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
7897 @item DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
7898 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
7899 for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
7900 provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
7901
7902 @findex DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
7903 @item DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
7904 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
7905 for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
7906 ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
7907
7908 @findex DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
7909 @item DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
7910 The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
7911 passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
7912 do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
7913
7914 @findex DBX_MEMPARM_STABS_LETTER
7915 @item DBX_MEMPARM_STABS_LETTER
7916 The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a stack
7917 parameter. The default is @code{'p'}.
7918
7919 @findex DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
7920 @item DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
7921 Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
7922 arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
7923 in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
7924 code.
7925
7926 @findex DBX_LBRAC_FIRST
7927 @item DBX_LBRAC_FIRST
7928 Define this macro if the @code{N_LBRAC} symbol for a block should
7929 precede the debugging information for variables and functions defined in
7930 that block. Normally, in DBX format, the @code{N_LBRAC} symbol comes
7931 first.
7932
7933 @findex DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
7934 @item DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
7935 Define this macro if the value of a symbol describing the scope of a
7936 block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be relative to the start
7937 of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
7938
7939 @findex DBX_USE_BINCL
7940 @item DBX_USE_BINCL
7941 Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
7942 @code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
7943 macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
7944 number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
7945 generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
7946 number for a type number.
7947 @end table
7948
7949 @node DBX Hooks
7950 @subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
7951
7952 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7953 These are hooks for DBX format.
7954
7955 @table @code
7956 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC
7957 @item DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7958 Define this macro to say how to output to @var{stream} the debugging
7959 information for the start of a scope level for variable names. The
7960 argument @var{name} is the name of an assembler symbol (for use with
7961 @code{assemble_name}) whose value is the address where the scope begins.
7962
7963 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC
7964 @item DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7965 Like @code{DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC}, but for the end of a scope level.
7966
7967 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_NFUN
7968 @item DBX_OUTPUT_NFUN (@var{stream}, @var{lscope_label}, @var{decl})
7969 Define this macro if the target machine requires special handling to
7970 output an @code{N_FUN} entry for the function @var{decl}.
7971
7972 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_ENUM
7973 @item DBX_OUTPUT_ENUM (@var{stream}, @var{type})
7974 Define this macro if the target machine requires special handling to
7975 output an enumeration type. The definition should be a C statement
7976 (sans semicolon) to output the appropriate information to @var{stream}
7977 for the type @var{type}.
7978
7979 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_END
7980 @item DBX_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_END (@var{stream}, @var{function})
7981 Define this macro if the target machine requires special output at the
7982 end of the debugging information for a function. The definition should
7983 be a C statement (sans semicolon) to output the appropriate information
7984 to @var{stream}. @var{function} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} node for
7985 the function.
7986
7987 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_STANDARD_TYPES
7988 @item DBX_OUTPUT_STANDARD_TYPES (@var{syms})
7989 Define this macro if you need to control the order of output of the
7990 standard data types at the beginning of compilation. The argument
7991 @var{syms} is a @code{tree} which is a chain of all the predefined
7992 global symbols, including names of data types.
7993
7994 Normally, DBX output starts with definitions of the types for integers
7995 and characters, followed by all the other predefined types of the
7996 particular language in no particular order.
7997
7998 On some machines, it is necessary to output different particular types
7999 first. To do this, define @code{DBX_OUTPUT_STANDARD_TYPES} to output
8000 those symbols in the necessary order. Any predefined types that you
8001 don't explicitly output will be output afterward in no particular order.
8002
8003 Be careful not to define this macro so that it works only for C@. There
8004 are no global variables to access most of the built-in types, because
8005 another language may have another set of types. The way to output a
8006 particular type is to look through @var{syms} to see if you can find it.
8007 Here is an example:
8008
8009 @smallexample
8010 @{
8011 tree decl;
8012 for (decl = syms; decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
8013 if (!strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (decl)),
8014 "long int"))
8015 dbxout_symbol (decl);
8016 @dots{}
8017 @}
8018 @end smallexample
8019
8020 @noindent
8021 This does nothing if the expected type does not exist.
8022
8023 See the function @code{init_decl_processing} in @file{c-decl.c} to find
8024 the names to use for all the built-in C types.
8025
8026 Here is another way of finding a particular type:
8027
8028 @c this is still overfull. --mew 10feb93
8029 @smallexample
8030 @{
8031 tree decl;
8032 for (decl = syms; decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
8033 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL
8034 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))
8035 == INTEGER_CST)
8036 && TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == 16
8037 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
8038 @group
8039 /* @r{This must be @code{unsigned short}.} */
8040 dbxout_symbol (decl);
8041 @dots{}
8042 @}
8043 @end group
8044 @end smallexample
8045
8046 @findex NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
8047 @item NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
8048 Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
8049 @code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
8050 On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
8051 disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
8052
8053 @end table
8054
8055 @node File Names and DBX
8056 @subsection File Names in DBX Format
8057
8058 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8059 This describes file names in DBX format.
8060
8061 @table @code
8062 @findex DBX_WORKING_DIRECTORY
8063 @item DBX_WORKING_DIRECTORY
8064 Define this if DBX wants to have the current directory recorded in each
8065 object file.
8066
8067 Note that the working directory is always recorded if GDB extensions are
8068 enabled.
8069
8070 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME
8071 @item DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8072 A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
8073 @var{stream} which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
8074 file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
8075 This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
8076
8077 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
8078 for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
8079
8080 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
8081 @item DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8082 A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
8083 @var{stream} which indicates that the current directory during
8084 compilation is named @var{name}.
8085
8086 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
8087 for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
8088
8089 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
8090 @item DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8091 A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
8092 compilation of the main source file @var{name}.
8093
8094 If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
8095 of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
8096
8097 @findex DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME
8098 @item DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8099 A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
8100 @var{stream} which indicates that file @var{name} is the current source
8101 file. This output is generated each time input shifts to a different
8102 source file as a result of @samp{#include}, the end of an included file,
8103 or a @samp{#line} command.
8104
8105 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
8106 for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
8107 @end table
8108
8109 @need 2000
8110 @node SDB and DWARF
8111 @subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
8112
8113 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8114 Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
8115
8116 @table @code
8117 @findex SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
8118 @item SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
8119 Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
8120 for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
8121
8122 @findex DWARF_DEBUGGING_INFO
8123 @item DWARF_DEBUGGING_INFO
8124 Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf format debugging output
8125 in response to the @option{-g} option.
8126
8127 @findex DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
8128 @item DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
8129 Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
8130 debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
8131
8132 To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
8133 define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
8134 @code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
8135 prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
8136 as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
8137
8138 @findex DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
8139 @item DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
8140 Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
8141 Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}
8142 (@pxref{Exception Region Output} is nonzero, GCC will output this
8143 information not matter how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
8144
8145 @findex LINKER_DOES_NOT_WORK_WITH_DWARF2
8146 @item LINKER_DOES_NOT_WORK_WITH_DWARF2
8147 Define this macro if the linker does not work with Dwarf version 2.
8148 Normally, if the user specifies only @option{-ggdb} GCC will use Dwarf
8149 version 2 if available; this macro disables this. See the description
8150 of the @code{PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE} macro for more details.
8151
8152 @findex DWARF2_GENERATE_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
8153 @item DWARF2_GENERATE_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
8154 By default, the Dwarf 2 debugging information generator will generate a
8155 label to mark the beginning of the text section. If it is better simply
8156 to use the name of the text section itself, rather than an explicit label,
8157 to indicate the beginning of the text section, define this macro to zero.
8158
8159 @findex DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
8160 @item DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
8161 Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
8162 line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
8163 tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
8164
8165 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA
8166 @item ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
8167 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
8168 between the two given labels, using an integer of the given size.
8169
8170 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET
8171 @item ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
8172 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
8173 section-relative reference to the given label, using an integer of the
8174 given size.
8175
8176 @findex ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL
8177 @item ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
8178 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
8179 reference to the given label, using an integer of the given size.
8180
8181 @findex PUT_SDB_@dots{}
8182 @item PUT_SDB_@dots{}
8183 Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
8184 SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
8185 macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
8186 not define them yourself.
8187
8188 @findex SDB_DELIM
8189 @item SDB_DELIM
8190 Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
8191 SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
8192 delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
8193 a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
8194 required.
8195
8196 @findex SDB_GENERATE_FAKE
8197 @item SDB_GENERATE_FAKE
8198 Define this macro to override the usual method of constructing a dummy
8199 name for anonymous structure and union types. See @file{sdbout.c} for
8200 more information.
8201
8202 @findex SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
8203 @item SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
8204 Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
8205 union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
8206 allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
8207 it.
8208
8209 @findex SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
8210 @item SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
8211 Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
8212 enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
8213 assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
8214 @end table
8215
8216 @need 2000
8217 @node VMS Debug
8218 @subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
8219
8220 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8221 Here are macros for VMS debug format.
8222
8223 @table @code
8224 @findex VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
8225 @item VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
8226 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
8227 in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
8228 is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
8229 @option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
8230 behavior is controlled by @code{OPTIMIZATION_OPTIONS} and
8231 @code{OVERRIDE_OPTIONS}.
8232 @end table
8233
8234 @node Floating Point
8235 @section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
8236 @cindex cross compilation and floating point
8237 @cindex floating point and cross compilation
8238
8239 While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
8240 there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
8241 means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
8242 in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
8243 doing the compilation.
8244
8245 Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
8246 range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
8247 the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
8248 safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
8249 the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
8250 emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
8251 target floating point formats are identical.
8252
8253 The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
8254 use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
8255 floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
8256 their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
8257
8258 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
8259 The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
8260 machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
8261 array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
8262 quantity.
8263 @end defmac
8264
8265 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
8266 Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}. If the target
8267 floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
8268 @samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
8269 @samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
8270 @end deftypefn
8271
8272 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
8273 Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
8274 @end deftypefn
8275
8276 @deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
8277 Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
8278 @end deftypefn
8279
8280 @deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
8281 Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
8282 @var{x} is negative, returns zero.
8283 @end deftypefn
8284
8285 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
8286 Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
8287 representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
8288 decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
8289 defined by the C language for both.
8290 @end deftypefn
8291
8292 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
8293 Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
8294 @end deftypefn
8295
8296 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
8297 Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
8298 @end deftypefn
8299
8300 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
8301 Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
8302 @end deftypefn
8303
8304 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
8305 Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
8306 @var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
8307 variable).
8308
8309 The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}. Only the
8310 following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
8311 @code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
8312
8313 If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
8314 target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
8315 @code{abort}. Callers should check for this situation first, using
8316 @code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}. @xref{Storage Layout}.
8317 @end deftypefn
8318
8319 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
8320 Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
8321 @end deftypefn
8322
8323 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
8324 Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
8325 @end deftypefn
8326
8327 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_TRUNCATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{x})
8328 Truncates the floating point value @var{x} to fit in @var{mode}. The
8329 return value is still a full-size @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, but it has an
8330 appropriate bit pattern to be output asa floating constant whose
8331 precision accords with mode @var{mode}.
8332 @end deftypefn
8333
8334 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
8335 Converts a floating point value @var{x} into a double-precision integer
8336 which is then stored into @var{low} and @var{high}. If the value is not
8337 integral, it is truncated.
8338 @end deftypefn
8339
8340 @deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
8341 @findex REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT
8342 Converts a double-precision integer found in @var{low} and @var{high},
8343 into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}. The
8344 value is truncated to fit in mode @var{mode}.
8345 @end deftypefn
8346
8347 @node Mode Switching
8348 @section Mode Switching Instructions
8349 @cindex mode switching
8350 The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
8351
8352 @table @code
8353 @findex OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING
8354 @item OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
8355 Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
8356 switching in an optimizing compilation.
8357
8358 For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
8359 floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
8360 the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
8361 operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
8362 purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
8363 be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
8364 or @code{MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
8365
8366 You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
8367 which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
8368 return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
8369 If you define this macro, you also have to define
8370 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
8371 @code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
8372 @code{NORMAL_MODE} is optional.
8373
8374 @findex NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
8375 @item NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
8376 If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
8377 initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
8378 N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
8379 of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
8380 The position of the initializer in the initializer - starting counting at
8381 zero - determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
8382 entity in question.
8383 In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
8384 represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
8385 switch is needed / supplied.
8386
8387 @findex MODE_NEEDED
8388 @item MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
8389 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
8390 @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
8391 return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
8392 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
8393 be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
8394
8395 @findex NORMAL_MODE
8396 @item NORMAL_MODE (@var{entity})
8397 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
8398 mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
8399 @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry and exit.
8400
8401 @findex MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE
8402 @item MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
8403 This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
8404 0 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
8405 lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
8406 for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
8407 (@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
8408 @code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
8409
8410 @findex EMIT_MODE_SET
8411 @item EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
8412 Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
8413 @var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
8414 the insn(s) are to be inserted.
8415 @end table
8416
8417 @node Target Attributes
8418 @section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
8419 @cindex target attributes
8420 @cindex machine attributes
8421 @cindex attributes, target-specific
8422
8423 Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
8424 These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
8425 be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
8426
8427 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const struct attribute_spec *} TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
8428 If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
8429 attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
8430 specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
8431 entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
8432 take.
8433 @end deftypevr
8434
8435 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
8436 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
8437 @var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
8438 and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
8439 generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
8440 supposed always to be compatible.
8441 @end deftypefn
8442
8443 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type})
8444 If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
8445 newly defined @var{type}.
8446 @end deftypefn
8447
8448 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
8449 Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
8450 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
8451 @code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
8452 that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
8453 function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
8454 merging.
8455 @end deftypefn
8456
8457 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{olddecl}, tree @var{newdecl})
8458 Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
8459 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
8460 @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
8461 @var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
8462 when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
8463 attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
8464 call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
8465
8466 @findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
8467 If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport} for
8468 Windows targets, you should define the macro
8469 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. This links in a function
8470 called @code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined
8471 as the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. This is done
8472 in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and @file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
8473 @end deftypefn
8474
8475 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{node}, tree *@var{attr_ptr})
8476 Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
8477 when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
8478 wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
8479 the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
8480 created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
8481 for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
8482 shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
8483 the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
8484 attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
8485 needed.
8486 @end deftypefn
8487
8488 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P (tree @var{fndecl})
8489 @cindex inlining
8490 This target hook returns @code{true} if it is ok to inline @var{fndecl}
8491 into the current function, despite its having target-specific
8492 attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
8493 target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
8494 @end deftypefn
8495
8496 @node MIPS Coprocessors
8497 @section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
8498 @cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
8499
8500 The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
8501 coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. gcc supports
8502 accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
8503 and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
8504
8505 @smallexample
8506 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
8507 unsigned int d;
8508
8509 d = cp0count + 3;
8510 @end smallexample
8511
8512 (``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
8513 names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
8514 overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
8515
8516 Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
8517 be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
8518 later in the function.
8519
8520 Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
8521 the FPU. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
8522 floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
8523
8524 There is one macro used in defining the MIPS coprocessor interface which
8525 you may want to override in subtargets; it is described below.
8526
8527 @table @code
8528
8529 @item ALL_COP_ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8530 @findex ALL_COP_ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8531 A comma-separated list (with leading comma) of pairs describing the
8532 alternate names of coprocessor registers. The format of each entry should be
8533 @smallexample
8534 @{ @var{alternatename}, @var{register_number}@}
8535 @end smallexample
8536 Default: empty.
8537
8538 @end table
8539
8540 @node Misc
8541 @section Miscellaneous Parameters
8542 @cindex parameters, miscellaneous
8543
8544 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8545 Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
8546
8547 @table @code
8548 @item PREDICATE_CODES
8549 @findex PREDICATE_CODES
8550 Define this if you have defined special-purpose predicates in the file
8551 @file{@var{machine}.c}. This macro is called within an initializer of an
8552 array of structures. The first field in the structure is the name of a
8553 predicate and the second field is an array of rtl codes. For each
8554 predicate, list all rtl codes that can be in expressions matched by the
8555 predicate. The list should have a trailing comma. Here is an example
8556 of two entries in the list for a typical RISC machine:
8557
8558 @smallexample
8559 #define PREDICATE_CODES \
8560 @{"gen_reg_rtx_operand", @{SUBREG, REG@}@}, \
8561 @{"reg_or_short_cint_operand", @{SUBREG, REG, CONST_INT@}@},
8562 @end smallexample
8563
8564 Defining this macro does not affect the generated code (however,
8565 incorrect definitions that omit an rtl code that may be matched by the
8566 predicate can cause the compiler to malfunction). Instead, it allows
8567 the table built by @file{genrecog} to be more compact and efficient,
8568 thus speeding up the compiler. The most important predicates to include
8569 in the list specified by this macro are those used in the most insn
8570 patterns.
8571
8572 For each predicate function named in @code{PREDICATE_CODES}, a
8573 declaration will be generated in @file{insn-codes.h}.
8574
8575 @item SPECIAL_MODE_PREDICATES
8576 @findex SPECIAL_MODE_PREDICATES
8577 Define this if you have special predicates that know special things
8578 about modes. Genrecog will warn about certain forms of
8579 @code{match_operand} without a mode; if the operand predicate is
8580 listed in @code{SPECIAL_MODE_PREDICATES}, the warning will be
8581 suppressed.
8582
8583 Here is an example from the IA-32 port (@code{ext_register_operand}
8584 specially checks for @code{HImode} or @code{SImode} in preparation
8585 for a byte extraction from @code{%ah} etc.).
8586
8587 @smallexample
8588 #define SPECIAL_MODE_PREDICATES \
8589 "ext_register_operand",
8590 @end smallexample
8591
8592 @findex CASE_VECTOR_MODE
8593 @item CASE_VECTOR_MODE
8594 An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
8595 elements of a jump-table should have.
8596
8597 @findex CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE
8598 @item CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
8599 Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
8600 when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
8601 it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
8602 To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
8603 make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
8604 The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
8605 flags can be updated.
8606
8607 @findex CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
8608 @item CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
8609 Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
8610 should contain relative addresses. If jump-tables never contain
8611 relative addresses, then you need not define this macro.
8612
8613 @findex CASE_DROPS_THROUGH
8614 @item CASE_DROPS_THROUGH
8615 Define this if control falls through a @code{case} insn when the index
8616 value is out of range. This means the specified default-label is
8617 actually ignored by the @code{case} insn proper.
8618
8619 @findex CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
8620 @item CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
8621 Define this to be the smallest number of different values for which it
8622 is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
8623 The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
8624 five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
8625
8626 @findex CASE_USE_BIT_TESTS
8627 @item CASE_USE_BIT_TESTS
8628 Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate whether C switch
8629 statements may be implemented by a sequence of bit tests. This is
8630 advantageous on processors that can efficiently implement left shift
8631 of 1 by the number of bits held in a register, but inappropriate on
8632 targets that would require a loop. By default, this macro returns
8633 @code{true} if the target defines an @code{ashlsi3} pattern, and
8634 @code{false} otherwise.
8635
8636 @findex WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
8637 @item WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
8638 Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
8639 smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
8640 Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
8641
8642 @findex LOAD_EXTEND_OP
8643 @item LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mode})
8644 Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
8645 memory in @var{mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
8646 bits outside of @var{mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
8647 zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
8648 of @var{mode} for which the
8649 insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
8650 @code{NIL} for other modes.
8651
8652 This macro is not called with @var{mode} non-integral or with a width
8653 greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
8654 value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
8655 @code{NIL}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
8656 define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
8657
8658 @findex SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
8659 @item SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
8660 Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
8661 extends.
8662
8663 @findex FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
8664 @item FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
8665 Define this macro if the same instructions that convert a floating
8666 point number to a signed fixed point number also convert validly to an
8667 unsigned one.
8668
8669 @findex MOVE_MAX
8670 @item MOVE_MAX
8671 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
8672 between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
8673
8674 @findex MAX_MOVE_MAX
8675 @item MAX_MOVE_MAX
8676 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
8677 between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
8678 is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
8679 constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
8680 at run-time.
8681
8682 @findex SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
8683 @item SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
8684 A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
8685 actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
8686 of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
8687 this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
8688 a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
8689 truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
8690 instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
8691 include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
8692 also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
8693 arguments to bit-field instructions.
8694
8695 If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
8696 position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
8697 instructions exist, you should define this macro.
8698
8699 However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
8700 only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
8701 bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
8702 such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
8703 the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
8704
8705 You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
8706
8707 @findex TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION
8708 @item TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
8709 A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
8710 ``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
8711 bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
8712 operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
8713
8714 On many machines, this expression can be 1.
8715
8716 @c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
8717 @c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
8718 When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
8719 modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
8720 If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
8721 such cases may improve things.
8722
8723 @findex STORE_FLAG_VALUE
8724 @item STORE_FLAG_VALUE
8725 A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
8726 with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
8727 (@samp{s@var{cond}}) when the condition is true. This description must
8728 apply to @emph{all} the @samp{s@var{cond}} patterns and all the
8729 comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
8730
8731 A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
8732 comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
8733 and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
8734 which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
8735 true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
8736 operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
8737 @samp{s@var{cond}} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
8738 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
8739 the compiler.
8740
8741 If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
8742 generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
8743 replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
8744 the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
8745 For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
8746 @code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
8747 @samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
8748 expression
8749
8750 @smallexample
8751 (ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
8752 @end smallexample
8753
8754 @noindent
8755 can be converted to
8756
8757 @smallexample
8758 (ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
8759 @end smallexample
8760
8761 @noindent
8762 where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
8763 tested into the sign bit.
8764
8765 There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
8766 for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
8767 but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
8768 are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
8769 perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
8770 comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
8771
8772 Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
8773 from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
8774 choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
8775 to be used:
8776
8777 @itemize @bullet
8778 @item
8779 Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
8780 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
8781 ``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
8782 comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
8783 combine the normalization with other operations.
8784
8785 @item
8786 For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
8787 slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
8788 other machines.
8789
8790 @item
8791 As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
8792 exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
8793 others.
8794
8795 @item
8796 Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
8797 @end itemize
8798
8799 Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
8800 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
8801 instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
8802 those cases, e.g., one matching
8803
8804 @smallexample
8805 (set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
8806 @end smallexample
8807
8808 Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
8809 condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
8810 @samp{s@var{cond}} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
8811 machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
8812 and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
8813 @code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
8814 @file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptizer can be used to
8815 find such instruction sequences on other machines.
8816
8817 You need not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
8818 instructions.
8819
8820 @findex FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE
8821 @item FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
8822 A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
8823 returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
8824 Define this macro on machine that have comparison operations that return
8825 floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
8826 this macro.
8827
8828 @findex CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO
8829 @findex CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO
8830 @item CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
8831 @itemx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
8832 A C expression that evaluates to true if the architecture defines a value
8833 for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand. If so, @var{value}
8834 should be set to this value. If this macro is not defined, the value of
8835 @code{clz} or @code{ctz} is assumed to be undefined.
8836
8837 This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
8838 relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
8839 is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases.
8840
8841 Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
8842 and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
8843 visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
8844 to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
8845 breaking the API.
8846
8847 @findex Pmode
8848 @item Pmode
8849 An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
8850 this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
8851 pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
8852 On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
8853 modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
8854
8855 The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
8856 @code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
8857 @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
8858 to @code{Pmode}.
8859
8860 @findex FUNCTION_MODE
8861 @item FUNCTION_MODE
8862 An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
8863 being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most machines this
8864 should be @code{QImode}.
8865
8866 @findex INTEGRATE_THRESHOLD
8867 @item INTEGRATE_THRESHOLD (@var{decl})
8868 A C expression for the maximum number of instructions above which the
8869 function @var{decl} should not be inlined. @var{decl} is a
8870 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} node.
8871
8872 The default definition of this macro is 64 plus 8 times the number of
8873 arguments that the function accepts. Some people think a larger
8874 threshold should be used on RISC machines.
8875
8876 @findex STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
8877 @item STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
8878 In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
8879 constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
8880 hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
8881 where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
8882 strict conformance to the C Standard.
8883
8884 Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
8885 convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
8886 files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
8887
8888 @findex NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
8889 @item NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
8890 Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
8891 This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
8892 C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
8893 @samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
8894
8895 @findex HANDLE_PRAGMA
8896 @item HANDLE_PRAGMA (@var{getc}, @var{ungetc}, @var{name})
8897 This macro is no longer supported. You must use
8898 @code{REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS} instead.
8899
8900 @findex REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS
8901 @findex #pragma
8902 @findex pragma
8903 @item REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
8904 Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
8905 If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
8906 @code{c_register_pragma} for each pragma. The macro may also do any
8907 setup required for the pragmas.
8908
8909 The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
8910 other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
8911 definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
8912
8913 If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
8914 defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
8915
8916 Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
8917 @samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
8918 silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
8919
8920 @deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
8921
8922 Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} establishes one pragma. The
8923 @var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
8924 pragma of the form
8925
8926 @smallexample
8927 #pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
8928 @end smallexample
8929
8930 @var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
8931 @code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
8932 routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
8933 on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
8934 @var{name} by calling @code{c_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
8935 callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
8936 a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}.
8937
8938 For an example use of this routine, see @file{c4x.h} and the callback
8939 routines defined in @file{c4x-c.c}.
8940
8941 Note that the use of @code{c_lex} is specific to the C and C++
8942 compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
8943 other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{c_lex} is going
8944 to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
8945 building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
8946 variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
8947 target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
8948 the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
8949 code that uses @code{c_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
8950 rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
8951 how to build this object file.
8952 @end deftypefun
8953
8954 @findex HANDLE_SYSV_PRAGMA
8955 @findex #pragma
8956 @findex pragma
8957 @item HANDLE_SYSV_PRAGMA
8958 Define this macro (to a value of 1) if you want the System V style
8959 pragmas @samp{#pragma pack(<n>)} and @samp{#pragma weak <name>
8960 [=<value>]} to be supported by gcc.
8961
8962 The pack pragma specifies the maximum alignment (in bytes) of fields
8963 within a structure, in much the same way as the @samp{__aligned__} and
8964 @samp{__packed__} @code{__attribute__}s do. A pack value of zero resets
8965 the behavior to the default.
8966
8967 A subtlety for Microsoft Visual C/C++ style bit-field packing
8968 (e.g. -mms-bitfields) for targets that support it:
8969 When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
8970 of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
8971 bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
8972 and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
8973 chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
8974 size is allocated).
8975
8976 If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
8977 the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
8978 used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
8979 precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
8980 may affect its placement.
8981
8982 The weak pragma only works if @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK} and
8983 @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} are defined. If enabled it allows the creation
8984 of specifically named weak labels, optionally with a value.
8985
8986 @findex HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_PUSH_POP
8987 @findex #pragma
8988 @findex pragma
8989 @item HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_PUSH_POP
8990 Define this macro (to a value of 1) if you want to support the Win32
8991 style pragmas @samp{#pragma pack(push,@var{n})} and @samp{#pragma
8992 pack(pop)}. The @samp{pack(push,@var{n})} pragma specifies the maximum alignment
8993 (in bytes) of fields within a structure, in much the same way as the
8994 @samp{__aligned__} and @samp{__packed__} @code{__attribute__}s do. A
8995 pack value of zero resets the behavior to the default. Successive
8996 invocations of this pragma cause the previous values to be stacked, so
8997 that invocations of @samp{#pragma pack(pop)} will return to the previous
8998 value.
8999
9000 @findex DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
9001 @item DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
9002 Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in identifier
9003 names. 0 means @samp{$} is not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed.
9004 1 is the default; there is no need to define this macro in that case.
9005 This macro controls the compiler proper; it does not affect the preprocessor.
9006
9007 @findex NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
9008 @item NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
9009 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
9010 @samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
9011 G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
9012 @samp{.} is used instead.
9013
9014 @findex NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
9015 @item NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
9016 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
9017 @samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
9018 have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
9019 are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
9020
9021 @findex DEFAULT_MAIN_RETURN
9022 @item DEFAULT_MAIN_RETURN
9023 Define this macro if the target system expects every program's @code{main}
9024 function to return a standard ``success'' value by default (if no other
9025 value is explicitly returned).
9026
9027 The definition should be a C statement (sans semicolon) to generate the
9028 appropriate rtl instructions. It is used only when compiling the end of
9029 @code{main}.
9030
9031 @item NEED_ATEXIT
9032 @findex NEED_ATEXIT
9033 Define this if the target system lacks the function @code{atexit}
9034 from the ISO C standard. If this macro is defined, a default definition
9035 will be provided to support C++. If @code{ON_EXIT} is not defined,
9036 a default @code{exit} function will also be provided.
9037
9038 @item ON_EXIT
9039 @findex ON_EXIT
9040 Define this macro if the target has another way to implement atexit
9041 functionality without replacing @code{exit}. For instance, SunOS 4 has
9042 a similar @code{on_exit} library function.
9043
9044 The definition should be a functional macro which can be used just like
9045 the @code{atexit} function.
9046
9047 @item EXIT_BODY
9048 @findex EXIT_BODY
9049 Define this if your @code{exit} function needs to do something
9050 besides calling an external function @code{_cleanup} before
9051 terminating with @code{_exit}. The @code{EXIT_BODY} macro is
9052 only needed if @code{NEED_ATEXIT} is defined and @code{ON_EXIT} is not
9053 defined.
9054
9055 @findex INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED
9056 @item INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
9057 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
9058 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
9059 even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
9060 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
9061 every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
9062 or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
9063 you should define this macro.
9064
9065 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
9066
9067 @findex INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED
9068 @item INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
9069 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
9070 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
9071 even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
9072 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
9073 some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
9074 are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
9075 define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
9076 instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
9077 slot of @var{insn}.
9078
9079 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
9080
9081 @findex MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG
9082 @item MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG (@var{insn})
9083 In rare cases, correct code generation requires extra machine
9084 dependent processing between the second jump optimization pass and
9085 delayed branch scheduling. On those machines, define this macro as a C
9086 statement to act on the code starting at @var{insn}.
9087
9088 @findex MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
9089 @item MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
9090 Define this macro if in some cases global symbols from one translation
9091 unit may not be bound to undefined symbols in another translation unit
9092 without user intervention. For instance, under Microsoft Windows
9093 symbols must be explicitly imported from shared libraries (DLLs).
9094
9095 @findex MD_ASM_CLOBBERS
9096 @item MD_ASM_CLOBBERS (@var{clobbers})
9097 A C statement that adds to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
9098 any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for all asms.
9099
9100 @findex MAX_INTEGER_COMPUTATION_MODE
9101 @item MAX_INTEGER_COMPUTATION_MODE
9102 Define this to the largest integer machine mode which can be used for
9103 operations other than load, store and copy operations.
9104
9105 You need only define this macro if the target holds values larger than
9106 @code{word_mode} in general purpose registers. Most targets should not define
9107 this macro.
9108
9109 @findex MATH_LIBRARY
9110 @item MATH_LIBRARY
9111 Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
9112 in the system math library, or @samp{""} if the target does not have a
9113 separate math library.
9114
9115 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"-lm"} is wrong.
9116
9117 @findex LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
9118 @item LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
9119 Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
9120 specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
9121
9122 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
9123 is wrong.
9124
9125 @findex TARGET_HAS_F_SETLKW
9126 @item TARGET_HAS_F_SETLKW
9127 Define this macro if the target supports file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
9128 Note that this functionality is part of POSIX@.
9129 Defining @code{TARGET_HAS_F_SETLKW} will enable the test coverage code
9130 to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
9131 if the program has forked.
9132
9133 @findex MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
9134 @item MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
9135
9136 A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
9137 conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
9138 @code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
9139 1 if it does use cc0.
9140
9141 @findex IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS
9142 @item IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS(@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
9143 Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
9144 conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
9145 @var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
9146 contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
9147 and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
9148 then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
9149 @var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
9150
9151 @findex IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS
9152 @item IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS(@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
9153 Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
9154 if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
9155 @var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
9156 being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
9157
9158 @findex IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN
9159 @item IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN(@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
9160 A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
9161 be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
9162 a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
9163 about the currently processed blocks.
9164
9165 @findex IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL
9166 @item IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL(@var{ce_info})
9167 A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
9168 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
9169 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
9170 to by @var{ce_info}.
9171
9172 @findex IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL
9173 @item IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL(@var{ce_info})
9174 A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
9175 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
9176 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
9177 to by @var{ce_info}.
9178
9179 @findex IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS
9180 @item IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS(@var{ce_info})
9181 A C expression to initialize any extra fields in a @code{struct ce_if_block}
9182 structure, which are defined by the @code{IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
9183
9184 @findex IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS
9185 @item IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS
9186 If defined, it should expand to a set of field declarations that will be
9187 added to the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure. These should be initialized
9188 by the @code{IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
9189
9190 @end table
9191
9192 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS ()
9193 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
9194 that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
9195 necessary setup.
9196
9197 Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
9198 instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
9199 they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
9200 instructions or prefetch instructions).
9201
9202 To create a built-in function, call the function @code{builtin_function}
9203 which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
9204 up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes} and @code{build_common_tree_nodes_2};
9205 only language front ends that use those two functions will call
9206 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
9207 @end deftypefn
9208
9209 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN (tree @var{exp}, rtx @var{target}, rtx @var{subtarget}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{ignore})
9210
9211 Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
9212 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
9213 function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
9214 convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
9215 @var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
9216 @var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
9217 ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
9218 built-in function.
9219 @end deftypefn
9220
9221 @table @code
9222 @findex MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH
9223 @item MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH(@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
9224
9225 Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
9226 Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
9227 @var{branch2} is possible.
9228
9229 On some targets, branches may have a limited range. Optimizing the
9230 filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
9231 may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
9232
9233 @findex ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE
9234 @item ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE(@var{hard_reg})
9235
9236 When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
9237 register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
9238 to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
9239 it has been saved into can be used. @code{ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}, if
9240 defined, is called at the start of register allocation once for each
9241 hard register that had its initial value copied by using
9242 @code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
9243 Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
9244 to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
9245 the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
9246 @code{MEM}.
9247 If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
9248 it might decide to use another register anyways.
9249 You may use @code{current_function_leaf_function} in the definition of the
9250 macro, functions that use @code{REG_N_SETS}, to determine if the hard
9251 register in question will not be clobbered.
9252
9253 @findex TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
9254 @item TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
9255 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
9256 files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
9257 use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
9258
9259 @findex TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
9260 @item TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
9261 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
9262 automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
9263 do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
9264 executable files.
9265
9266 @findex COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
9267 @item COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
9268 If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
9269 specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
9270 Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
9271 object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
9272 lists.
9273
9274 @findex MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL
9275 @item MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
9276 Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
9277 method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
9278 must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
9279 For example, on 32-bit Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
9280 the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
9281 defined as this expression:
9282
9283 @smallexample
9284 build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
9285 build_tree_list
9286 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
9287 NULL))
9288 @end smallexample
9289
9290 @end table
9291
9292 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P (void)
9293 This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
9294 instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
9295 every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
9296 reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
9297
9298 @smallexample
9299 static bool
9300 cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
9301 @{
9302 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
9303 @}
9304 @end smallexample
9305 @end deftypefn